]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git/blame - gdb/doc/gdb.texinfo
Change profiling so that it is enabled by default. Re-generate everything.
[thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
CommitLineData
c906108c 1\input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
6d2ebf8b 2@c Copyright 1988-2000
c906108c
SS
3@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4@c
5d161b24 5@c %**start of header
c906108c
SS
6@c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
7@c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
8@setfilename gdb.info
9@c
10@include gdb-cfg.texi
11@c
c906108c 12@settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
13@setchapternewpage odd
14@c %**end of header
15
16@iftex
17@c @smallbook
18@c @cropmarks
19@end iftex
20
21@finalout
22@syncodeindex ky cp
23
41afff9a
EZ
24@c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
25@c annotate.texi uses @findex.
c906108c 26@syncodeindex vr cp
41afff9a 27@syncodeindex fn cp
c906108c 28
7162c0ca
EZ
29@c gdbmi uses @findex
30@syncodeindex fn cp
31
c906108c 32@c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
6d2ebf8b 33@set EDITION Eighth
c906108c
SS
34
35@c !!set GDB manual's revision date
6d2ebf8b 36@set DATE March 2000
c906108c 37
6d2ebf8b 38@c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 3.12 OR LATER.
c906108c 39
c906108c 40@c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
6d2ebf8b 41@c manuals to an info tree.
96a2c332
SS
42@dircategory Programming & development tools.
43@direntry
c906108c 44* Gdb: (gdb). The @sc{gnu} debugger.
96a2c332
SS
45@end direntry
46
c906108c
SS
47@ifinfo
48This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
49
50
5d161b24 51This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE},
c906108c
SS
52of @cite{Debugging with @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger}
53for @value{GDBN} Version @value{GDBVN}.
54
6d2ebf8b 55Copyright (C) 1988-2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
c906108c
SS
56
57Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of
58this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice
59are preserved on all copies.
60
61@ignore
62Permission is granted to process this file through TeX and print the
63results, provided the printed document carries copying permission
64notice identical to this one except for the removal of this paragraph
65(this paragraph not being relevant to the printed manual).
66
67@end ignore
68Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified versions of this
69manual under the conditions for verbatim copying, provided also that the
70entire resulting derived work is distributed under the terms of a
71permission notice identical to this one.
72
73Permission is granted to copy and distribute translations of this manual
74into another language, under the above conditions for modified versions.
75@end ifinfo
76
77@titlepage
78@title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
79@subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
c906108c 80@sp 1
c906108c
SS
81@subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
82@subtitle @value{DATE}
a7cb598a 83@author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et.al.
c906108c 84@page
c906108c
SS
85@tex
86{\parskip=0pt
53a5351d 87\hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
c906108c
SS
88\hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
89\hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
90}
91@end tex
53a5351d 92
c906108c 93@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
6d2ebf8b 94Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
c906108c 95@sp 2
c906108c
SS
96Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
9759 Temple Place - Suite 330, @*
98Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA @*
6d2ebf8b
SS
99ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
100
c906108c
SS
101Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of
102this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice
103are preserved on all copies.
104
105Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified versions of this
106manual under the conditions for verbatim copying, provided also that the
107entire resulting derived work is distributed under the terms of a
108permission notice identical to this one.
109
110Permission is granted to copy and distribute translations of this manual
111into another language, under the above conditions for modified versions.
112@end titlepage
113@page
114
b9deaee7 115@ifinfo
6d2ebf8b
SS
116@node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
117
c906108c
SS
118@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
119
120This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
121
5d161b24 122This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
c906108c
SS
123@value{GDBVN}.
124
6d2ebf8b
SS
125Copyright (C) 1988-2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
126
127@menu
128* Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
129* Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
130
131* Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
132* Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
133* Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
134* Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
135* Stack:: Examining the stack
136* Source:: Examining source files
137* Data:: Examining data
138
139* Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
140
141* Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
142* Altering:: Altering execution
143* GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
144* Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
145* Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
146* Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
147* Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
148* Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
149* Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
7162c0ca 150* GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
6d2ebf8b
SS
151
152* GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
153* Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
154
155* Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
156* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
157* Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
158* Index:: Index
159@end menu
160
b9deaee7 161@end ifinfo
6d2ebf8b
SS
162
163@c the replication sucks, but this avoids a texinfo 3.12 lameness
164
165@ifhtml
166@node Top
167
168@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
169
170This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
171
172This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
173@value{GDBVN}.
174
175Copyright (C) 1988-2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
176
c906108c
SS
177@menu
178* Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
c906108c 179* Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
c906108c
SS
180
181* Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
182* Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
183* Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
184* Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
185* Stack:: Examining the stack
186* Source:: Examining source files
187* Data:: Examining data
c906108c 188
7a292a7a 189* Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
c906108c
SS
190
191* Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
192* Altering:: Altering execution
193* GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
194* Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
104c1213 195* Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
c906108c
SS
196* Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
197* Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
c906108c 198* Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
6d2ebf8b 199* Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
c906108c
SS
200
201* GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
c906108c 202* Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
c906108c
SS
203
204* Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
205* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
206* Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
207* Index:: Index
c906108c
SS
208@end menu
209
6d2ebf8b
SS
210@end ifhtml
211
212@node Summary
c906108c
SS
213@unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
214
215The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
216going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
217program was doing at the moment it crashed.
218
219@value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
220these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
221
222@itemize @bullet
223@item
224Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
225
226@item
227Make your program stop on specified conditions.
228
229@item
230Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
231
232@item
233Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
234effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
235@end itemize
236
cce74817 237You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C++.
c906108c 238For more information, see @ref{Support,,Supported languages}.
c906108c
SS
239For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
240
cce74817
JM
241@cindex Chill
242@cindex Modula-2
c906108c 243Support for Modula-2 and Chill is partial. For information on Modula-2,
cce74817 244see @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}. For information on Chill, see @ref{Chill}.
c906108c 245
cce74817
JM
246@cindex Pascal
247Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
248nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
249entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
250syntax.
c906108c 251
c906108c
SS
252@cindex Fortran
253@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
53a5351d 254it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
cce74817 255underscore.
c906108c 256
c906108c
SS
257@menu
258* Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
259* Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
260@end menu
261
6d2ebf8b 262@node Free Software
c906108c
SS
263@unnumberedsec Free software
264
5d161b24 265@value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
c906108c
SS
266General Public License
267(GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
268program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
269freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
270the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
271Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
272Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
273
274Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
275you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
276from anyone else.
277
6d2ebf8b 278@node Contributors
96a2c332
SS
279@unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
280
281Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
282other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
283development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
284of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
285to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
286file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
c906108c
SS
287blow-by-blow account.
288
289Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
290
291@quotation
292@emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
293or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
294omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
295@end quotation
296
297So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
298particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
299releases:
8c70017b 300Andrew Cagney (release 5.0);
c906108c
SS
301Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
302Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
303Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
304Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
305Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
306John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
307Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
308and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
309
310Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
311Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
312
96a2c332
SS
313Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C++ support in
314@value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
315Bothner. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C++ demangler. Early work on
316C++ was by Peter TerMaat (who also did much general update work leading
317to release 3.0).
c906108c
SS
318
319@value{GDBN} 4 uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
320object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
321Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
322
323David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
324the original support for encapsulated COFF.
325
326Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
327
328Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
329Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
330support.
331Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
332Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
333Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
334David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
335Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
336Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
337Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
338Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
339Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
340Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
341Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
342Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
343Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
344Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
345Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
346
347Andreas Schwab contributed M68K Linux support.
348
349Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
350libraries.
351
352Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
353about several machine instruction sets.
354
355Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
356remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
357contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
358and RDI targets, respectively.
359
360Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
361command-line editing and command history.
362
7a292a7a
SS
363Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
364Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
c906108c 365
5d161b24 366Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
c906108c
SS
367He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C++ overloaded
368symbols.
c906108c
SS
369
370Hitachi America, Ltd. sponsored the support for H8/300, H8/500, and
371Super-H processors.
372
373NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
374
375Mitsubishi sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D processors.
376
377Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
378
379Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
380
96a2c332 381Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
c906108c
SS
382
383Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
384watchpoints.
385
386Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
387
388Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
389
390Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
96a2c332 391nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
392
393The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
394support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
395(narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC++
396compiler, and the terminal user interface: Ben Krepp, Richard Title,
397John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann, Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve
398Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase provided HP-specific
399information in this manual.
400
96a2c332
SS
401Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
402development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
2df3850c
JM
403fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
404Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
405Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
406Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
407Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
408addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
409JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
410Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
411Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
412Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
413Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
414Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
415Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
c906108c
SS
416
417
6d2ebf8b 418@node Sample Session
c906108c
SS
419@chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
420
421You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
422However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
423debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
424
425@iftex
426In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
427to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
428@end iftex
429
430@c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
431@c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
432
433One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
434processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
435quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
436definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
437session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
438then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
439same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
440@code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
441procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
442
443@smallexample
444$ @b{cd gnu/m4}
445$ @b{./m4}
446@b{define(foo,0000)}
447
448@b{foo}
4490000
450@b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
451
452@b{bar}
4530000
454@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
455
456@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
457@b{baz}
458@b{C-d}
459m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
460@end smallexample
461
462@noindent
463Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
464
c906108c
SS
465@smallexample
466$ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
467@c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
468@c FIXME... format to come out better.
469@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
5d161b24 470 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
c906108c 471 the conditions.
5d161b24 472There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
c906108c
SS
473 for details.
474
475@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
476(@value{GDBP})
477@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
478
479@noindent
480@value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
481rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
482We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
483that examples fit in this manual.
484
485@smallexample
486(@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
487@end smallexample
488
489@noindent
490We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
491Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
492@code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
493@code{break} command.
494
495@smallexample
496(@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
497Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
498@end smallexample
499
500@noindent
501Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
502control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
503subroutine, the program runs as usual:
504
505@smallexample
506(@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
507Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
508@b{define(foo,0000)}
509
510@b{foo}
5110000
512@end smallexample
513
514@noindent
515To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
516suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
517context where it stops.
518
519@smallexample
520@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
521
5d161b24 522Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
c906108c
SS
523 at builtin.c:879
524879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
525@end smallexample
526
527@noindent
528Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
529the next line of the current function.
530
531@smallexample
532(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
533882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
534 : nil,
535@end smallexample
536
537@noindent
538@code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
539by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
540@code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
541subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
542
543@smallexample
544(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
545set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
546 at input.c:530
547530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
548@end smallexample
549
550@noindent
551The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
552suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
553shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
554command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
555in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
556stack frame for each active subroutine.
557
558@smallexample
559(@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
560#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
561 at input.c:530
5d161b24 562#1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
c906108c
SS
563 at builtin.c:882
564#2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
565#3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
566 at macro.c:71
567#4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
568#5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
569@end smallexample
570
571@noindent
572We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
573times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
574falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
575
576@smallexample
577(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
5780x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
579(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
5800x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
581def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
582(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
583536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
584 : xstrdup(rq);
585(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
586538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
587@end smallexample
588
589@noindent
590The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
591@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
592and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
593(@code{print}) to see their values.
594
595@smallexample
596(@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
597$1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
598(@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
599$2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
600@end smallexample
601
602@noindent
603@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
604To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
605surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
606
607@smallexample
608(@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
609533 xfree(rquote);
610534
611535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
612 : xstrdup (lq);
613536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
614 : xstrdup (rq);
615537
616538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
617539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
618540 @}
619541
620542 void
621@end smallexample
622
623@noindent
624Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
625@code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
626
627@smallexample
628(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
629539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
630(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
631540 @}
632(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
633$3 = 9
634(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
635$4 = 7
636@end smallexample
637
638@noindent
639That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
640@code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
641@code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
642the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
643any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
644assignments.
645
646@smallexample
647(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
648$5 = 7
649(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
650$6 = 9
651@end smallexample
652
653@noindent
654Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
655@code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
656executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
657example that caused trouble initially:
658
659@smallexample
660(@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
661Continuing.
662
663@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
664
665baz
6660000
667@end smallexample
668
669@noindent
670Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
671problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
672lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
673
674@smallexample
675@b{C-d}
676Program exited normally.
677@end smallexample
678
679@noindent
680The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
681indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
682session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
683
684@smallexample
685(@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
686@end smallexample
c906108c 687
6d2ebf8b 688@node Invocation
c906108c
SS
689@chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
690
691This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
5d161b24 692The essentials are:
c906108c 693@itemize @bullet
5d161b24 694@item
53a5351d 695type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
5d161b24 696@item
c906108c
SS
697type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{C-d} to exit.
698@end itemize
699
700@menu
701* Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
702* Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
703* Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
704@end menu
705
6d2ebf8b 706@node Invoking GDB
c906108c
SS
707@section Invoking @value{GDBN}
708
c906108c
SS
709Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
710@value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
711
712You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
713to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
714
c906108c
SS
715The command-line options described here are designed
716to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
5d161b24 717options may effectively be unavailable.
c906108c
SS
718
719The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
720specifying an executable program:
721
722@example
723@value{GDBP} @var{program}
724@end example
725
c906108c
SS
726@noindent
727You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
728specified:
729
730@example
731@value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
732@end example
733
734You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
735to debug a running process:
736
737@example
738@value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
739@end example
740
741@noindent
742would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
743named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
744
c906108c 745Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
2df3850c
JM
746complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
747debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
748``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
749will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
c906108c 750
96a2c332 751You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
c906108c
SS
752@value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
753
754@smallexample
755@value{GDBP} -silent
756@end smallexample
757
758@noindent
759You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
760options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
761
762@noindent
763Type
764
765@example
766@value{GDBP} -help
767@end example
768
769@noindent
770to display all available options and briefly describe their use
771(@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
772
773All options and command line arguments you give are processed
774in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
775@samp{-x} option is used.
776
777
778@menu
c906108c
SS
779* File Options:: Choosing files
780* Mode Options:: Choosing modes
781@end menu
782
6d2ebf8b 783@node File Options
c906108c
SS
784@subsection Choosing files
785
2df3850c 786When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
c906108c
SS
787specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
788the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
789@samp{-c} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the first argument
790that does not have an associated option flag as equivalent to the
791@samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the second argument
792that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as equivalent to
793the @samp{-c} option followed by that argument.)
7a292a7a
SS
794
795If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
796such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
797argument and ignore it.
c906108c
SS
798
799Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
800following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
801them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
802(If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
803than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
804
d700128c
EZ
805@c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
806@c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
807@c it.
808
c906108c
SS
809@table @code
810@item -symbols @var{file}
811@itemx -s @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
812@cindex @code{--symbols}
813@cindex @code{-s}
c906108c
SS
814Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
815
816@item -exec @var{file}
817@itemx -e @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
818@cindex @code{--exec}
819@cindex @code{-e}
7a292a7a
SS
820Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
821and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
c906108c
SS
822
823@item -se @var{file}
d700128c 824@cindex @code{--se}
c906108c
SS
825Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
826file.
827
c906108c
SS
828@item -core @var{file}
829@itemx -c @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
830@cindex @code{--core}
831@cindex @code{-c}
c906108c
SS
832Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
833
834@item -c @var{number}
835Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command
836(unless there is a file in core-dump format named @var{number}, in which
837case @samp{-c} specifies that file as a core dump to read).
c906108c
SS
838
839@item -command @var{file}
840@itemx -x @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
841@cindex @code{--command}
842@cindex @code{-x}
c906108c
SS
843Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
844Files,, Command files}.
845
846@item -directory @var{directory}
847@itemx -d @var{directory}
d700128c
EZ
848@cindex @code{--directory}
849@cindex @code{-d}
c906108c
SS
850Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
851
c906108c
SS
852@item -m
853@itemx -mapped
d700128c
EZ
854@cindex @code{--mapped}
855@cindex @code{-m}
c906108c
SS
856@emph{Warning: this option depends on operating system facilities that are not
857supported on all systems.}@*
858If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the @code{mmap}
5d161b24 859system call, you can use this option
c906108c
SS
860to have @value{GDBN} write the symbols from your
861program into a reusable file in the current directory. If the program you are debugging is
96a2c332 862called @file{/tmp/fred}, the mapped symbol file is @file{/tmp/fred.syms}.
c906108c
SS
863Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions notice the presence of this file,
864and can quickly map in symbol information from it, rather than reading
865the symbol table from the executable program.
866
867The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where @value{GDBN}
868is run. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN} symbol
869table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c 870
c906108c
SS
871@item -r
872@itemx -readnow
d700128c
EZ
873@cindex @code{--readnow}
874@cindex @code{-r}
c906108c
SS
875Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
876the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
877This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
53a5351d 878
c906108c
SS
879@end table
880
2df3850c 881You typically combine the @code{-mapped} and @code{-readnow} options in
c906108c 882order to build a @file{.syms} file that contains complete symbol
2df3850c
JM
883information. (@xref{Files,,Commands to specify files}, for information
884on @file{.syms} files.) A simple @value{GDBN} invocation to do nothing
885but build a @file{.syms} file for future use is:
c906108c
SS
886
887@example
2df3850c 888gdb -batch -nx -mapped -readnow programname
c906108c 889@end example
c906108c 890
6d2ebf8b 891@node Mode Options
c906108c
SS
892@subsection Choosing modes
893
894You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
895batch mode or quiet mode.
896
897@table @code
898@item -nx
899@itemx -n
d700128c
EZ
900@cindex @code{--nx}
901@cindex @code{-n}
2df3850c
JM
902Do not execute commands found in any initialization files (normally
903called @file{.gdbinit}, or @file{gdb.ini} on PCs). Normally,
904@value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
905options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
906files}.
c906108c
SS
907
908@item -quiet
d700128c 909@itemx -silent
c906108c 910@itemx -q
d700128c
EZ
911@cindex @code{--quiet}
912@cindex @code{--silent}
913@cindex @code{-q}
c906108c
SS
914``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
915messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
916
917@item -batch
d700128c 918@cindex @code{--batch}
c906108c
SS
919Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
920command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
921initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
922nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
923in the command files.
924
2df3850c
JM
925Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
926example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
927make this more useful, the message
c906108c
SS
928
929@example
930Program exited normally.
931@end example
932
933@noindent
2df3850c
JM
934(which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
935@value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
936mode.
937
938@item -nowindows
939@itemx -nw
d700128c
EZ
940@cindex @code{--nowindows}
941@cindex @code{-nw}
2df3850c 942``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
96a2c332 943(GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
2df3850c
JM
944interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
945
946@item -windows
947@itemx -w
d700128c
EZ
948@cindex @code{--windows}
949@cindex @code{-w}
2df3850c
JM
950If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
951used if possible.
c906108c
SS
952
953@item -cd @var{directory}
d700128c 954@cindex @code{--cd}
c906108c
SS
955Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
956instead of the current directory.
957
c906108c
SS
958@item -fullname
959@itemx -f
d700128c
EZ
960@cindex @code{--fullname}
961@cindex @code{-f}
7a292a7a
SS
962@sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
963subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
964number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
965displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
966recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
967the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
968and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
969@samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
970frame.
c906108c 971
d700128c
EZ
972@item -epoch
973@cindex @code{--epoch}
974The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
975@value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
976routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
977separate window.
978
979@item -annotate @var{level}
980@cindex @code{--annotate}
981This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
982effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
983(@pxref{Annotations}).
984Annotation level controls how much information does @value{GDBN} print
985together with its prompt, values of expressions, source lines, and other
986types of output. Level 0 is the normal, level 1 is for use when
987@value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 2 is the
988maximum annotation suitable for programs that control @value{GDBN}.
989
990@item -async
991@cindex @code{--async}
992Use the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
993@value{GDBN} processes all events, such as user keyboard input, via a
994special event loop. This allows @value{GDBN} to accept and process user
995commands in parallel with the debugged process being
996run@footnote{@value{GDBN} built with @sc{djgpp} tools for
997MS-DOS/MS-Windows supports this mode of operation, but the event loop is
998suspended when the debuggee runs.}, so you don't need to wait for
999control to return to @value{GDBN} before you type the next command.
1000(@emph{Note:} as of version 5.0, the target side of the asynchronous
1001operation is not yet in place, so @samp{-async} does not work fully
1002yet.)
1003@c FIXME: when the target side of the event loop is done, the above NOTE
1004@c should be removed.
1005
1006When the standard input is connected to a terminal device, @value{GDBN}
1007uses the asynchronous event loop by default, unless disabled by the
1008@samp{-noasync} option.
1009
1010@item -noasync
1011@cindex @code{--noasync}
1012Disable the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1013
2df3850c
JM
1014@item -baud @var{bps}
1015@itemx -b @var{bps}
d700128c
EZ
1016@cindex @code{--baud}
1017@cindex @code{-b}
c906108c
SS
1018Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1019interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
c906108c
SS
1020
1021@item -tty @var{device}
d700128c
EZ
1022@itemx -t @var{device}
1023@cindex @code{--tty}
1024@cindex @code{-t}
c906108c
SS
1025Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1026@c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
c906108c 1027
53a5351d
JM
1028@c resolve the situation of these eventually
1029@c @item -tui
d700128c 1030@c @cindex @code{--tui}
53a5351d
JM
1031@c Use a Terminal User Interface. For information, use your Web browser to
1032@c read the file @file{TUI.html}, which is usually installed in the
1033@c directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX systems. Do not use
1034@c this option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (see @pxref{Emacs, ,Using
1035@c @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1036
1037@c @item -xdb
d700128c 1038@c @cindex @code{--xdb}
53a5351d
JM
1039@c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1040@c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1041@c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1042@c systems.
1043
d700128c
EZ
1044@item -interpreter @var{interp}
1045@cindex @code{--interpreter}
1046Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1047program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1048communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end. For example,
1049@samp{--interpreter=mi} causes @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{gdbmi
7162c0ca 1050interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, , The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}).
d700128c
EZ
1051
1052@item -write
1053@cindex @code{--write}
1054Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1055is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1056(@pxref{Patching}).
1057
1058@item -statistics
1059@cindex @code{--statistics}
1060This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1061memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1062
1063@item -version
1064@cindex @code{--version}
1065This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1066no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1067
c906108c
SS
1068@end table
1069
6d2ebf8b 1070@node Quitting GDB
c906108c
SS
1071@section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1072@cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1073@cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1074
1075@table @code
1076@kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
41afff9a 1077@kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
96a2c332
SS
1078@item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1079@itemx q
1080To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1081@code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{C-d}). If you
1082do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1083otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1084error code.
c906108c
SS
1085@end table
1086
1087@cindex interrupt
1088An interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1089terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1090returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1091character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1092until a time when it is safe.
1093
c906108c
SS
1094If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1095device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1096(@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
c906108c 1097
6d2ebf8b 1098@node Shell Commands
c906108c
SS
1099@section Shell commands
1100
1101If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1102debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1103just use the @code{shell} command.
1104
1105@table @code
1106@kindex shell
1107@cindex shell escape
1108@item shell @var{command string}
1109Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
c906108c 1110If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
d4f3574e
SS
1111shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1112(@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
c906108c
SS
1113@end table
1114
1115The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1116You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1117@value{GDBN}:
1118
1119@table @code
1120@kindex make
1121@cindex calling make
1122@item make @var{make-args}
1123Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1124arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1125@end table
1126
6d2ebf8b 1127@node Commands
c906108c
SS
1128@chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1129
1130You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1131name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1132@value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1133key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1134show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1135
1136@menu
1137* Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1138* Completion:: Command completion
1139* Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1140@end menu
1141
6d2ebf8b 1142@node Command Syntax
c906108c
SS
1143@section Command syntax
1144
1145A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1146how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1147arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1148command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1149step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
96a2c332 1150with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
c906108c
SS
1151
1152@cindex abbreviation
1153@value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1154unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1155documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1156abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1157equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1158names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1159arguments to the @code{help} command.
1160
1161@cindex repeating commands
41afff9a 1162@kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
c906108c 1163A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
96a2c332 1164repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
c906108c
SS
1165will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1166repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1167repeat.
1168
1169The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1170@key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1171exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1172
1173@value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1174output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1175(@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1176@key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1177repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1178
41afff9a 1179@kindex # @r{(a comment)}
c906108c
SS
1180@cindex comment
1181Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1182nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1183Files,,Command files}).
1184
6d2ebf8b 1185@node Completion
c906108c
SS
1186@section Command completion
1187
1188@cindex completion
1189@cindex word completion
1190@value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1191only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1192are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1193commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1194
1195Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1196of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1197word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1198enter it). For example, if you type
1199
1200@c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1201@c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1202@c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1203@c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1204@example
1205(@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1206@end example
1207
1208@noindent
1209@value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1210the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1211
1212@example
1213(@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1214@end example
1215
1216@noindent
1217You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1218breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1219@samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1220were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1221might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1222to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1223
1224If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1225@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1226characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1227@value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1228example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1229begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1230just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1231function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1232example:
1233
1234@example
1235(@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1236@exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
5d161b24
DB
1237make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1238make_abs_section make_function_type
1239make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1240make_cleanup make_reference_type
c906108c
SS
1241make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1242(@value{GDBP}) b make_
1243@end example
1244
1245@noindent
1246After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1247partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1248command.
1249
1250If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1251can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
7a292a7a 1252means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
c906108c 1253key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
7a292a7a 1254one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
c906108c
SS
1255
1256@cindex quotes in commands
1257@cindex completion of quoted strings
1258Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
7a292a7a
SS
1259parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1260its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1261situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1262@value{GDBN} commands.
c906108c 1263
c906108c
SS
1264The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1265name of a C++ function. This is because C++ allows function overloading
1266(multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished by argument
1267type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you may need to
1268distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name} that takes an
1269@code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version that takes a
1270@code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the word-completion
1271facilities in this situation, type a single quote @code{'} at the
1272beginning of the function name. This alerts @value{GDBN} that it may need to
1273consider more information than usual when you press @key{TAB} or
1274@kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1275
1276@example
96a2c332 1277(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
c906108c
SS
1278bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1279(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1280@end example
1281
1282In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1283quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1284completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1285place:
1286
1287@example
1288(@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1289@exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1290(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1291@end example
1292
1293@noindent
1294In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1295you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1296completion on an overloaded symbol.
1297
d4f3574e 1298For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
c906108c
SS
1299expressions, ,C++ expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1300overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
d4f3574e 1301see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C++}.
c906108c
SS
1302
1303
6d2ebf8b 1304@node Help
c906108c
SS
1305@section Getting help
1306@cindex online documentation
1307@kindex help
1308
5d161b24 1309You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
c906108c
SS
1310using the command @code{help}.
1311
1312@table @code
41afff9a 1313@kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
c906108c
SS
1314@item help
1315@itemx h
1316You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1317display a short list of named classes of commands:
1318
1319@smallexample
1320(@value{GDBP}) help
1321List of classes of commands:
1322
2df3850c 1323aliases -- Aliases of other commands
c906108c 1324breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
2df3850c 1325data -- Examining data
c906108c 1326files -- Specifying and examining files
2df3850c
JM
1327internals -- Maintenance commands
1328obscure -- Obscure features
1329running -- Running the program
1330stack -- Examining the stack
c906108c
SS
1331status -- Status inquiries
1332support -- Support facilities
96a2c332
SS
1333tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without@*
1334 stopping the program
c906108c 1335user-defined -- User-defined commands
c906108c 1336
5d161b24 1337Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
c906108c 1338commands in that class.
5d161b24 1339Type "help" followed by command name for full
c906108c
SS
1340documentation.
1341Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1342(@value{GDBP})
1343@end smallexample
96a2c332 1344@c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
c906108c
SS
1345
1346@item help @var{class}
1347Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1348list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1349help display for the class @code{status}:
1350
1351@smallexample
1352(@value{GDBP}) help status
1353Status inquiries.
1354
1355List of commands:
1356
1357@c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1358@c to fit in smallbook page size.
2df3850c
JM
1359info -- Generic command for showing things
1360 about the program being debugged
1361show -- Generic command for showing things
1362 about the debugger
c906108c 1363
5d161b24 1364Type "help" followed by command name for full
c906108c
SS
1365documentation.
1366Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1367(@value{GDBP})
1368@end smallexample
1369
1370@item help @var{command}
1371With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1372short paragraph on how to use that command.
1373
6837a0a2
DB
1374@kindex apropos
1375@item apropos @var{args}
1376The @code{apropos @var{args}} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1377commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1378@var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1379
1380@smallexample
1381apropos reload
1382@end smallexample
1383
1384@noindent results in:
1385
1386@smallexample
6d2ebf8b
SS
1387@c @group
1388set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1389 multiple times in one run
1390show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1391 multiple times in one run
1392@c @end group
6837a0a2
DB
1393@end smallexample
1394
c906108c
SS
1395@kindex complete
1396@item complete @var{args}
1397The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1398for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1399command you want completed. For example:
1400
1401@smallexample
1402complete i
1403@end smallexample
1404
1405@noindent results in:
1406
1407@smallexample
1408@group
2df3850c
JM
1409if
1410ignore
c906108c
SS
1411info
1412inspect
c906108c
SS
1413@end group
1414@end smallexample
1415
1416@noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1417@end table
1418
1419In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1420and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1421of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1422manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1423under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1424all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1425
1426@c @group
1427@table @code
1428@kindex info
41afff9a 1429@kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
c906108c
SS
1430@item info
1431This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1432program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1433with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1434registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1435You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1436@w{@code{help info}}.
1437
1438@kindex set
1439@item set
5d161b24 1440You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
c906108c
SS
1441@code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1442@code{set prompt $}.
1443
1444@kindex show
1445@item show
5d161b24 1446In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
c906108c
SS
1447@value{GDBN} itself.
1448You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1449related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1450system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1451which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1452
1453@kindex info set
1454To display all the settable parameters and their current
1455values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1456@code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1457@c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1458@c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1459@c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1460@end table
1461@c @end group
1462
1463Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1464exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1465
1466@table @code
1467@kindex show version
1468@cindex version number
1469@item show version
1470Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
2df3850c
JM
1471information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1472@value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1473version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1474commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1475system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
96a2c332 1476variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
2df3850c
JM
1477The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1478@value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
1479
1480@kindex show copying
1481@item show copying
1482Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1483
1484@kindex show warranty
1485@item show warranty
2df3850c 1486Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
96a2c332 1487if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
2df3850c 1488
c906108c
SS
1489@end table
1490
6d2ebf8b 1491@node Running
c906108c
SS
1492@chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1493
1494When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1495debugging information when you compile it.
7a292a7a
SS
1496
1497You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1498of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1499your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1500kill a child process.
c906108c
SS
1501
1502@menu
1503* Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1504* Starting:: Starting your program
c906108c
SS
1505* Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1506* Environment:: Your program's environment
c906108c
SS
1507
1508* Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1509* Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1510* Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1511* Kill Process:: Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1512
1513* Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1514* Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1515@end menu
1516
6d2ebf8b 1517@node Compilation
c906108c
SS
1518@section Compiling for debugging
1519
1520In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1521debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1522is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1523variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1524and addresses in the executable code.
1525
1526To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1527the compiler.
1528
1529Many C compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O}
1530options together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1531executables containing debugging information.
1532
53a5351d
JM
1533@value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1534without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1535recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1536program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1537in pushing your luck.
c906108c
SS
1538
1539@cindex optimized code, debugging
1540@cindex debugging optimized code
1541When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1542optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1543really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1544exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1545variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1546variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1547
1548Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1549@samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1550doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1551please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1552
1553Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1554@w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1555format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1556
1557@need 2000
6d2ebf8b 1558@node Starting
c906108c
SS
1559@section Starting your program
1560@cindex starting
1561@cindex running
1562
1563@table @code
1564@kindex run
41afff9a 1565@kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
c906108c
SS
1566@item run
1567@itemx r
7a292a7a
SS
1568Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1569You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1570argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1571@value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1572(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
c906108c
SS
1573
1574@end table
1575
c906108c
SS
1576If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1577supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1578that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1579@code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1580
1581The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1582receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1583information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1584can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1585your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1586divided into four categories:
1587
1588@table @asis
1589@item The @emph{arguments.}
1590Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1591@code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1592is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1593(such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1594the arguments.
1595In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1596@code{SHELL} environment variable.
1597@xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1598
1599@item The @emph{environment.}
1600Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1601use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1602environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1603your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1604
1605@item The @emph{working directory.}
1606Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1607the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1608@xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1609
1610@item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1611Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1612standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1613in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1614set a different device for your program.
1615@xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1616
1617@cindex pipes
1618@emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1619pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1620program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1621wrong program.
1622@end table
c906108c
SS
1623
1624When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1625immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1626of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1627stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1628or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1629
1630If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1631time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1632table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1633your current breakpoints.
1634
6d2ebf8b 1635@node Arguments
c906108c
SS
1636@section Your program's arguments
1637
1638@cindex arguments (to your program)
1639The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
5d161b24 1640@code{run} command.
c906108c
SS
1641They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1642performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1643@code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1644@value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
d4f3574e
SS
1645the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1646
1647On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1648@value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1649calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1650the program, not by the shell.
c906108c
SS
1651
1652@code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1653@code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1654
c906108c 1655@table @code
41afff9a 1656@kindex set args
c906108c
SS
1657@item set args
1658Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1659@code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1660with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1661using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1662it again without arguments.
1663
1664@kindex show args
1665@item show args
1666Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1667@end table
1668
6d2ebf8b 1669@node Environment
c906108c
SS
1670@section Your program's environment
1671
1672@cindex environment (of your program)
1673The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1674their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1675your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1676path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1677the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1678debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1679environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1680
1681@table @code
1682@kindex path
1683@item path @var{directory}
1684Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
1685(the search path for executables), for both @value{GDBN} and your program.
d4f3574e
SS
1686You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1687system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1688MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1689is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
c906108c
SS
1690
1691You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1692working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1693use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1694@code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1695@var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1696@var{directory} to the search path.
1697@c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1698@c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1699
1700@kindex show paths
1701@item show paths
1702Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1703environment variable).
1704
1705@kindex show environment
1706@item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1707Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1708your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1709print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1710your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1711
1712@kindex set environment
53a5351d 1713@item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
1714Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1715changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1716be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1717any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1718parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
1719null value.
1720@c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
1721@c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
1722
1723For example, this command:
1724
1725@example
1726set env USER = foo
1727@end example
1728
1729@noindent
d4f3574e 1730tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
c906108c
SS
1731@samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
1732are not actually required.)
1733
1734@kindex unset environment
1735@item unset environment @var{varname}
1736Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
1737program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
1738@code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
1739rather than assigning it an empty value.
1740@end table
1741
d4f3574e
SS
1742@emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
1743the shell indicated
c906108c
SS
1744by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
1745@code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
1746that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
1747@file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
1748your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
1749files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
1750@file{.profile}.
1751
6d2ebf8b 1752@node Working Directory
c906108c
SS
1753@section Your program's working directory
1754
1755@cindex working directory (of your program)
1756Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
1757working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
1758The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
1759from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
1760working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
1761
1762The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
1763that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1764specify files}.
1765
1766@table @code
1767@kindex cd
1768@item cd @var{directory}
1769Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
1770
1771@kindex pwd
1772@item pwd
1773Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
1774@end table
1775
6d2ebf8b 1776@node Input/Output
c906108c
SS
1777@section Your program's input and output
1778
1779@cindex redirection
1780@cindex i/o
1781@cindex terminal
1782By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
5d161b24 1783the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
c906108c
SS
1784to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
1785modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
1786running your program.
1787
1788@table @code
1789@kindex info terminal
1790@item info terminal
1791Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
1792program is using.
1793@end table
1794
1795You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
1796redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
1797
1798@example
1799run > outfile
1800@end example
1801
1802@noindent
1803starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
1804
1805@kindex tty
1806@cindex controlling terminal
1807Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
1808with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
1809argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
1810commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
1811process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
1812
1813@example
1814tty /dev/ttyb
1815@end example
1816
1817@noindent
1818directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
1819default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
1820that as their controlling terminal.
1821
1822An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
1823effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
1824terminal.
1825
1826When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
1827command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
1828for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal.
1829
6d2ebf8b 1830@node Attach
c906108c
SS
1831@section Debugging an already-running process
1832@kindex attach
1833@cindex attach
1834
1835@table @code
1836@item attach @var{process-id}
1837This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
1838outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
1839targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
1840find out the process-id of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
1841or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
1842
1843@code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
1844executing the command.
1845@end table
1846
1847To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
1848which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
1849programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
1850also have permission to send the process a signal.
1851
1852When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
1853the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
1854the program is not found) by using the source file search path
1855(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
1856the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1857Specify Files}.
1858
1859The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
1860process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
53a5351d
JM
1861with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
1862you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
1863can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
1864process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
c906108c
SS
1865attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
1866
1867@table @code
1868@kindex detach
1869@item detach
1870When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
1871@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
1872the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
1873that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
1874are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
1875@code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
1876executing the command.
1877@end table
1878
1879If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
1880attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
1881for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
1882control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
1883confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
1884messages}).
1885
6d2ebf8b 1886@node Kill Process
c906108c 1887@section Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1888
1889@table @code
1890@kindex kill
1891@item kill
1892Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
1893@end table
1894
1895This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
1896running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
1897is running.
1898
1899On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
1900while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
1901@code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
1902outside the debugger.
1903
1904The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
1905relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
1906executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
1907next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
1908reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
1909breakpoint settings).
1910
6d2ebf8b 1911@node Threads
c906108c 1912@section Debugging programs with multiple threads
c906108c
SS
1913
1914@cindex threads of execution
1915@cindex multiple threads
1916@cindex switching threads
1917In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
1918may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
1919of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
1920the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
1921that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
1922modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
1923registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
1924
1925@value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
1926programs:
1927
1928@itemize @bullet
1929@item automatic notification of new threads
1930@item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
1931@item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
5d161b24 1932@item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
c906108c
SS
1933a command to apply a command to a list of threads
1934@item thread-specific breakpoints
1935@end itemize
1936
c906108c
SS
1937@quotation
1938@emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
1939@value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
1940If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
1941effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
1942from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
1943like this:
1944
1945@smallexample
1946(@value{GDBP}) info threads
1947(@value{GDBP}) thread 1
1948Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
1949see the IDs of currently known threads.
1950@end smallexample
1951@c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
1952@c doesn't support threads"?
1953@end quotation
c906108c
SS
1954
1955@cindex focus of debugging
1956@cindex current thread
1957The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
1958threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
1959control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
1960This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
1961program information from the perspective of the current thread.
1962
41afff9a 1963@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
c906108c
SS
1964@cindex thread identifier (system)
1965@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
1966@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
1967@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
1968Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
1969the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
1970form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
1971whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
1972LynxOS, you might see
1973
1974@example
1975[New process 35 thread 27]
1976@end example
1977
1978@noindent
1979when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
1980the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
1981further qualifier.
1982
1983@c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
1984@c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
1985@c second---i.e., when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
1986@c program?
1987@c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
1988@c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
5d161b24 1989@c threads ab initio?
c906108c
SS
1990
1991@cindex thread number
1992@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
1993For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
1994number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
1995
1996@table @code
1997@kindex info threads
1998@item info threads
1999Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2000program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2001
2002@enumerate
2003@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2004
2005@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2006
2007@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2008@end enumerate
2009
2010@noindent
2011An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2012indicates the current thread.
2013
5d161b24 2014For example,
c906108c
SS
2015@end table
2016@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2017
2018@smallexample
2019(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2020 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2021 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2022* 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2023 at threadtest.c:68
2024@end smallexample
53a5351d
JM
2025
2026On HP-UX systems:
c906108c
SS
2027
2028@cindex thread number
2029@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2030For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2031number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2032thread in your program.
2033
41afff9a
EZ
2034@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2035@cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
c906108c
SS
2036@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2037@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2038@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2039Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2040both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2041form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2042whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2043HP-UX, you see
2044
2045@example
2046[New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2047@end example
2048
2049@noindent
5d161b24 2050when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
c906108c
SS
2051
2052@table @code
2053@kindex info threads
2054@item info threads
2055Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2056program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2057
2058@enumerate
2059@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2060
2061@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2062
2063@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2064@end enumerate
2065
2066@noindent
2067An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2068indicates the current thread.
2069
5d161b24 2070For example,
c906108c
SS
2071@end table
2072@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2073
2074@example
2075(@value{GDBP}) info threads
6d2ebf8b
SS
2076 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2077 at quicksort.c:137
2078 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2079 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2080 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2081 from /usr/lib/libc.2
c906108c 2082@end example
c906108c
SS
2083
2084@table @code
2085@kindex thread @var{threadno}
2086@item thread @var{threadno}
2087Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2088argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2089shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2090@value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2091you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2092
2093@smallexample
2094@c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2095(@value{GDBP}) thread 2
c906108c 2096[Switching to process 35 thread 23]
c906108c
SS
20970x34e5 in sigpause ()
2098@end smallexample
2099
2100@noindent
2101As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2102@samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
5d161b24 2103threads.
c906108c
SS
2104
2105@kindex thread apply
2106@item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}
2107The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply a command to one or
2108more threads. Specify the numbers of the threads that you want affected
2109with the command argument @var{threadno}. @var{threadno} is the internal
2110@value{GDBN} thread number, as shown in the first field of the @samp{info
5d161b24
DB
2111threads} display. To apply a command to all threads, use
2112@code{thread apply all} @var{args}.
c906108c
SS
2113@end table
2114
2115@cindex automatic thread selection
2116@cindex switching threads automatically
2117@cindex threads, automatic switching
2118Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2119signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2120signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2121message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2122thread.
2123
2124@xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
2125more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2126programs with multiple threads.
2127
2128@xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
2129watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
c906108c 2130
6d2ebf8b 2131@node Processes
c906108c
SS
2132@section Debugging programs with multiple processes
2133
2134@cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2135@cindex multiple processes
2136@cindex processes, multiple
53a5351d
JM
2137On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2138programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2139function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2140parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2141set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2142will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2143will cause it to terminate.
c906108c
SS
2144
2145However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2146which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2147the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2148only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2149so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2150on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2151get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2152@value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
d4f3574e 2153the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
c906108c 2154the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
c906108c 2155
53a5351d
JM
2156On HP-UX (11.x and later only?), @value{GDBN} provides support for
2157debugging programs that create additional processes using the
2158@code{fork} or @code{vfork} function.
c906108c
SS
2159
2160By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2161the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2162
2163If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2164use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2165
2166@table @code
2167@kindex set follow-fork-mode
2168@item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2169Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2170@code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2171process. The @var{mode} can be:
2172
2173@table @code
2174@item parent
2175The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2df3850c 2176unimpeded. This is the default.
c906108c
SS
2177
2178@item child
2179The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2180unimpeded.
2181
2182@item ask
2183The debugger will ask for one of the above choices.
2184@end table
2185
2186@item show follow-fork-mode
2df3850c 2187Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
c906108c
SS
2188@end table
2189
2190If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2191@code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2192breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2193@code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2194the child process's @code{main}.
2195
2196When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2197child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2198
2199If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2200call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2201use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2202argument.
2203
2204You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2205a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2206Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
c906108c 2207
6d2ebf8b 2208@node Stopping
c906108c
SS
2209@chapter Stopping and Continuing
2210
2211The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2212program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2213trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2214
7a292a7a
SS
2215Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2216such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2217@value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2218change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2219continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2220ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2221explicitly request this information at any time.
c906108c
SS
2222
2223@table @code
2224@kindex info program
2225@item info program
2226Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
7a292a7a 2227running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
c906108c
SS
2228@end table
2229
2230@menu
2231* Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2232* Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
c906108c 2233* Signals:: Signals
c906108c 2234* Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
c906108c
SS
2235@end menu
2236
6d2ebf8b 2237@node Breakpoints
c906108c
SS
2238@section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2239
2240@cindex breakpoints
2241A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2242the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2243control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2244breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2245Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2246should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2247program.
2248
2249In HP-UX, SunOS 4.x, SVR4, and Alpha OSF/1 configurations, you can set
2250breakpoints in shared libraries before the executable is run. There is
2251a minor limitation on HP-UX systems: you must wait until the executable
2252is run in order to set breakpoints in shared library routines that are
2253not called directly by the program (for example, routines that are
2254arguments in a @code{pthread_create} call).
2255
2256@cindex watchpoints
2257@cindex memory tracing
2258@cindex breakpoint on memory address
2259@cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2260A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2261when the value of an expression changes. You must use a different
2262command to set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting
2263watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a watchpoint like
2264any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints
2265and watchpoints using the same commands.
2266
2267You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2268whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2269Automatic display}.
2270
2271@cindex catchpoints
2272@cindex breakpoint on events
2273A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2274when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C++
2275exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2276different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2277catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2278other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
d4f3574e 2279@code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
2280
2281@cindex breakpoint numbers
2282@cindex numbers for breakpoints
2283@value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2284catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2285starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2286features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2287breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2288@dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2289enable it again.
2290
c5394b80
JM
2291@cindex breakpoint ranges
2292@cindex ranges of breakpoints
2293Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2294operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2295@samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2296hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2297all breakpoint in that range are operated on.
2298
c906108c
SS
2299@menu
2300* Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2301* Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2302* Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2303* Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2304* Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2305* Conditions:: Break conditions
2306* Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
c906108c 2307* Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
d4f3574e 2308* Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
2309@end menu
2310
6d2ebf8b 2311@node Set Breaks
c906108c
SS
2312@subsection Setting breakpoints
2313
5d161b24 2314@c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
c906108c
SS
2315@c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2316@c
2317@c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2318
2319@kindex break
41afff9a
EZ
2320@kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2321@vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
2322@cindex latest breakpoint
2323Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
5d161b24 2324@code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
c906108c
SS
2325number of the breakpoints you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
2326Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2327convenience variables.
2328
2329You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2330
2331@table @code
2332@item break @var{function}
5d161b24 2333Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
c906108c
SS
2334When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
2335C++, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
2336@xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
c906108c
SS
2337
2338@item break +@var{offset}
2339@itemx break -@var{offset}
2340Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
d4f3574e 2341at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2df3850c 2342(@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
c906108c
SS
2343
2344@item break @var{linenum}
2345Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
d4f3574e
SS
2346The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2347The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
c906108c
SS
2348code on that line.
2349
2350@item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2351Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2352
2353@item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2354Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2355@var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2356superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2357functions.
2358
2359@item break *@var{address}
2360Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2361breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2362information or source files.
2363
2364@item break
2365When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2366the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2367(@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2368innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2369returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2370@code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2371that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2372@code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2373the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2374inside loops.
2375
2376@value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2377least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2378would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2379breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2380existed when your program stopped.
2381
2382@item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2383Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2384@var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2385value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2386@samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2387above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2388,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2389
2390@kindex tbreak
2391@item tbreak @var{args}
2392Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2393same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2394way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2395program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2396
c906108c
SS
2397@kindex hbreak
2398@item hbreak @var{args}
d4f3574e
SS
2399Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2400@code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
c906108c
SS
2401breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2402have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
d4f3574e
SS
2403debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2404changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2405provided by SPARClite DSU and some x86-based targets. These targets
2406will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2407address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2408breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2409example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2410@value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2411or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2412(@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2413
2414@kindex thbreak
2415@item thbreak @var{args}
2416Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2417are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
5d161b24 2418the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
c906108c
SS
2419the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2420first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
5d161b24
DB
2421command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2422may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
d4f3574e 2423See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2424
2425@kindex rbreak
2426@cindex regular expression
2427@item rbreak @var{regex}
c906108c 2428Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
11cf8741
JM
2429@var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2430matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2431breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2432the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2433them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2434
2435The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2436like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2437shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2438an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2439@code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2440match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
c906108c 2441
c906108c
SS
2442When debugging C++ programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
2443breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2444classes.
c906108c
SS
2445
2446@kindex info breakpoints
2447@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2448@item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2449@itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2450@itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2451Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2452not deleted, with the following columns for each breakpoint:
2453
2454@table @emph
2455@item Breakpoint Numbers
2456@item Type
2457Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2458@item Disposition
2459Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2460@item Enabled or Disabled
2461Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2462that are not enabled.
2463@item Address
2df3850c 2464Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address.
c906108c
SS
2465@item What
2466Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2467line number.
2468@end table
2469
2470@noindent
2471If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
2472the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
2473are listed after that.
2474
2475@noindent
2476@code{info break} with a breakpoint
2477number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
2478convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
2479the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
5d161b24 2480listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
c906108c
SS
2481
2482@noindent
2483@code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
2484has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
2485@code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
2486hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
2487was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
2488will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
2489@end table
2490
2491@value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
2492your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
2493the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
2494(@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
2495
2496@cindex negative breakpoint numbers
2497@cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
2498@value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for special
2499purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C programs).
2500These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers, starting with
2501@code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
2502
2503You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
2504@samp{maint info breakpoints}.
2505
2506@table @code
2507@kindex maint info breakpoints
2508@item maint info breakpoints
2509Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
2510breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
2511internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
2512breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
2513is shown:
2514
2515@table @code
2516@item breakpoint
2517Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
2518
2519@item watchpoint
2520Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
2521
2522@item longjmp
2523Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
2524@code{longjmp} calls.
2525
2526@item longjmp resume
2527Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
2528
2529@item until
2530Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
2531
2532@item finish
2533Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
2534
c906108c
SS
2535@item shlib events
2536Shared library events.
53a5351d 2537
c906108c 2538@end table
53a5351d 2539
c906108c
SS
2540@end table
2541
2542
6d2ebf8b 2543@node Set Watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2544@subsection Setting watchpoints
2545
2546@cindex setting watchpoints
2547@cindex software watchpoints
2548@cindex hardware watchpoints
2549You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
2550expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
2551this may happen.
2552
2553Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
2df3850c 2554hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
c906108c
SS
2555program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
2556times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
2557catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
2558culprit.)
2559
d4f3574e 2560On some systems, such as HP-UX, Linux and some other x86-based targets,
2df3850c 2561@value{GDBN} includes support for
c906108c
SS
2562hardware watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your
2563program.
2564
2565@table @code
2566@kindex watch
2567@item watch @var{expr}
2568Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when @var{expr}
2569is written into by the program and its value changes.
2570
2571@kindex rwatch
2572@item rwatch @var{expr}
2573Set a watchpoint that will break when watch @var{expr} is read by the program.
c906108c
SS
2574
2575@kindex awatch
2576@item awatch @var{expr}
2df3850c 2577Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read or written into
7be570e7 2578by the program.
c906108c
SS
2579
2580@kindex info watchpoints
2581@item info watchpoints
2582This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
2583it is the same as @code{info break}.
2584@end table
2585
2586@value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
2587watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
2588value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
2589cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
2590executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
2591statement, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
2592
2593When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
2594
2595@example
2596Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
2597@end example
2598
2599@noindent
2600if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
2601
7be570e7
JM
2602Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
2603hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
2604value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
2605every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
2606that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
2607hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
2608will print a message like this:
2609
2610@smallexample
2611Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
2612@end smallexample
2613
2614Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
2615data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
2616watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
2617can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
2618cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
2619double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
2620wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
2621into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
2622
2623If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
2624to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
2625Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
2626time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
2627able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
2628warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
2629
2630@smallexample
2631Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
2632@end smallexample
2633
2634@noindent
2635If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
2636
2637The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
2638or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
2639data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
2640hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
2641both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
2642watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
2643@strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
2644watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
c906108c
SS
2645@value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
2646Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
2647
2648If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
2df3850c 2649any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
c906108c
SS
2650kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
2651
7be570e7
JM
2652@value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
2653(automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
2654they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
2655which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
2656being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
2657and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
2658rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
2659way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
2660@code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
2661
c906108c
SS
2662@quotation
2663@cindex watchpoints and threads
2664@cindex threads and watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2665@emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
2666usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
2667can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
2668you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
2669thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
2670can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
2671@value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
2672the expression.
53a5351d 2673
d4f3574e 2674@c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
53a5351d
JM
2675@emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
2676have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
2677watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
2678single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
2679change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
2680confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
2681software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
2682when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
2683watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
c906108c 2684@end quotation
c906108c 2685
6d2ebf8b 2686@node Set Catchpoints
c906108c 2687@subsection Setting catchpoints
d4f3574e 2688@cindex catchpoints, setting
c906108c
SS
2689@cindex exception handlers
2690@cindex event handling
2691
2692You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
2693kinds of program events, such as C++ exceptions or the loading of a
2694shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
2695
2696@table @code
2697@kindex catch
2698@item catch @var{event}
2699Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
2700@table @code
2701@item throw
2702@kindex catch throw
2703The throwing of a C++ exception.
2704
2705@item catch
2706@kindex catch catch
2707The catching of a C++ exception.
2708
2709@item exec
2710@kindex catch exec
2711A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2712
2713@item fork
2714@kindex catch fork
2715A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2716
2717@item vfork
2718@kindex catch vfork
2719A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2720
2721@item load
2722@itemx load @var{libname}
2723@kindex catch load
2724The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
2725@var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2726
2727@item unload
2728@itemx unload @var{libname}
2729@kindex catch unload
2730The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
2731of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2732@end table
2733
2734@item tcatch @var{event}
2735Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
2736automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
2737
2738@end table
2739
2740Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
2741
2742There are currently some limitations to C++ exception handling
2743(@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
2744
2745@itemize @bullet
2746@item
2747If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
2748control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
2749raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
2750returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
2751simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
2752that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
2753you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
2754disabled within interactive calls.
2755
2756@item
2757You cannot raise an exception interactively.
2758
2759@item
2760You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
2761@end itemize
2762
2763@cindex raise exceptions
2764Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
2765if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
2766stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
2767can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
2768breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
2769out where the exception was raised.
2770
2771To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
2772knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C++, exceptions are
2773raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
2774which has the following ANSI C interface:
2775
2776@example
2777 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
d4f3574e
SS
2778 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
2779 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
c906108c
SS
2780@end example
2781
2782@noindent
2783To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
2784unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
2785(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
2786
2787With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
2788that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
2789a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
2790breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
2791raised.
2792
2793
6d2ebf8b 2794@node Delete Breaks
c906108c
SS
2795@subsection Deleting breakpoints
2796
2797@cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2798@cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2799It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2800catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
2801to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
2802breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
2803
2804With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
2805where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
2806delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
2807their breakpoint numbers.
2808
2809It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
2810automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
2811when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
2812
2813@table @code
2814@kindex clear
2815@item clear
2816Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
2817selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
2818the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
2819breakpoint where your program just stopped.
2820
2821@item clear @var{function}
2822@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
2823Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the function @var{function}.
2824
2825@item clear @var{linenum}
2826@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2827Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified line.
2828
2829@cindex delete breakpoints
2830@kindex delete
41afff9a 2831@kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
c5394b80
JM
2832@item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2833Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
2834ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
c906108c
SS
2835breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
2836confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
2837@end table
2838
6d2ebf8b 2839@node Disabling
c906108c
SS
2840@subsection Disabling breakpoints
2841
2842@kindex disable breakpoints
2843@kindex enable breakpoints
2844Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
2845prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
2846it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
2847that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
2848
2849You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
2850the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
2851or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
2852@code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
2853catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
2854
2855A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
2856states of enablement:
2857
2858@itemize @bullet
2859@item
2860Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
2861with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
2862@item
2863Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
2864@item
2865Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
d4f3574e 2866disabled.
c906108c
SS
2867@item
2868Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
d4f3574e
SS
2869immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
2870set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
c906108c
SS
2871@end itemize
2872
2873You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
2874watchpoints, and catchpoints:
2875
2876@table @code
2877@kindex disable breakpoints
2878@kindex disable
41afff9a 2879@kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
c5394b80 2880@item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2881Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
2882listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
2883options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
2884case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
2885@code{disable} as @code{dis}.
2886
2887@kindex enable breakpoints
2888@kindex enable
c5394b80 2889@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2890Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
2891become effective once again in stopping your program.
2892
c5394b80 2893@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2894Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
2895of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
2896
c5394b80 2897@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2898Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
2899deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
2900@end table
2901
d4f3574e
SS
2902@c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
2903@c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
c906108c
SS
2904Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
2905,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
2906subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
2907the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
2908breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
2909breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
2910stepping}.)
2911
6d2ebf8b 2912@node Conditions
c906108c
SS
2913@subsection Break conditions
2914@cindex conditional breakpoints
2915@cindex breakpoint conditions
2916
2917@c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
5d161b24 2918@c in particular for a watchpoint?
c906108c
SS
2919The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
2920specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
2921breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
2922programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
2923a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
2924and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
2925
2926This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
2927situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
2928when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
2929by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
2930@samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
2931
2932Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
2933since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
2934it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
2935and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
2936one.
2937
2938Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
2939your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
2940that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
2941format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
2942unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
2943that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
2944program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
d4f3574e
SS
2945breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
2946conditions for the
c906108c
SS
2947purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
2948(@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
2949
2950Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
2951@samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
2952Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
2953with the @code{condition} command.
53a5351d 2954
c906108c
SS
2955You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
2956The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
2957@code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
2958catchpoint.
c906108c
SS
2959
2960@table @code
2961@kindex condition
2962@item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
2963Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
2964watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
2965breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
2966@var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
2967@code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
2968syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
d4f3574e
SS
2969referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
2970symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
2971prints an error message:
2972
2973@example
2974No symbol "foo" in current context.
2975@end example
2976
2977@noindent
c906108c
SS
2978@value{GDBN} does
2979not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
d4f3574e
SS
2980command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
2981@code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
c906108c
SS
2982
2983@item condition @var{bnum}
2984Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
2985an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
2986@end table
2987
2988@cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
2989A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
2990breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
2991useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
2992count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
2993is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
2994therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
2995ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
2996the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
2997value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
2998your program reaches it.
2999
3000@table @code
3001@kindex ignore
3002@item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3003Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3004The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3005execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3006takes no action.
3007
3008To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3009a count of zero.
3010
3011When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3012breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3013@code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3014Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
3015
3016If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3017condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3018@value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3019
3020You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3021as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3022is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3023variables}.
3024@end table
3025
3026Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3027
3028
6d2ebf8b 3029@node Break Commands
c906108c
SS
3030@subsection Breakpoint command lists
3031
3032@cindex breakpoint commands
3033You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3034commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3035example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3036enable other breakpoints.
3037
3038@table @code
3039@kindex commands
3040@kindex end
3041@item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3042@itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3043@itemx end
3044Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3045themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3046@code{end} to terminate the commands.
3047
3048To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3049follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3050
3051With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3052breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3053recently encountered).
3054@end table
3055
3056Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3057disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3058
3059You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3060use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3061that resumes execution.
3062
3063Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3064execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3065(even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3066another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3067ambiguities about which list to execute.
3068
3069@kindex silent
3070If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3071usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3072be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3073then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3074see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3075meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3076
3077The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3078print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3079breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
3080
3081For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3082value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3083
3084@example
3085break foo if x>0
3086commands
3087silent
3088printf "x is %d\n",x
3089cont
3090end
3091@end example
3092
3093One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3094you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3095of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3096erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3097to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3098so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3099command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3100
3101@example
3102break 403
3103commands
3104silent
3105set x = y + 4
3106cont
3107end
3108@end example
3109
6d2ebf8b 3110@node Breakpoint Menus
c906108c
SS
3111@subsection Breakpoint menus
3112@cindex overloading
3113@cindex symbol overloading
3114
3115Some programming languages (notably C++) permit a single function name
3116to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3117This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3118@samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3119a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3120something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3121particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3122you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3123waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3124options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3125sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3126@kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3127breakpoints.
3128
3129For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3130breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3131We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3132
3133@c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3134@smallexample
3135@group
3136(@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3137[0] cancel
3138[1] all
3139[2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3140[3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3141[4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3142[5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3143[6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3144[7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3145> 2 4 6
3146Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3147Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3148Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3149Multiple breakpoints were set.
3150Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3151 breakpoints.
3152(@value{GDBP})
3153@end group
3154@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3155
3156@c @ifclear BARETARGET
6d2ebf8b 3157@node Error in Breakpoints
d4f3574e 3158@subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
3159@c
3160@c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3161@c
d4f3574e
SS
3162Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3163any other process is running that program. In this situation,
5d161b24 3164attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
d4f3574e
SS
3165@value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3166
3167@example
3168Cannot insert breakpoints.
3169The same program may be running in another process.
3170@end example
3171
3172When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3173
3174@enumerate
3175@item
3176Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3177
3178@item
5d161b24 3179Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
d4f3574e 3180name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
5d161b24 3181that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
d4f3574e
SS
3182Then start your program again.
3183
3184@item
3185Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3186linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3187to nonsharable executables.
3188@end enumerate
c906108c
SS
3189@c @end ifclear
3190
d4f3574e
SS
3191A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3192hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3193
3194@c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3195@c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3196@smallexample
3197Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3198You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3199@end smallexample
3200
3201@noindent
3202This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3203only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3204watchpoints it needs to insert.
3205
3206When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3207hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3208
3209
6d2ebf8b 3210@node Continuing and Stepping
c906108c
SS
3211@section Continuing and stepping
3212
3213@cindex stepping
3214@cindex continuing
3215@cindex resuming execution
3216@dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3217completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3218one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3219line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
7a292a7a
SS
3220particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3221your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
d4f3574e
SS
3222it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3223@samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
3224
3225@table @code
3226@kindex continue
41afff9a
EZ
3227@kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3228@kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
c906108c
SS
3229@item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3230@itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3231@itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3232Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3233any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3234@var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3235ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3236@code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3237
3238The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3239stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3240@code{continue} is ignored.
3241
d4f3574e
SS
3242The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3243debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3244purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3245@code{continue}.
c906108c
SS
3246@end table
3247
3248To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3249(@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3250calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3251different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3252
3253A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3254(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3255beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3256is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3257and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3258interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3259
3260@table @code
3261@kindex step
41afff9a 3262@kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
c906108c
SS
3263@item step
3264Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3265line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3266abbreviated @code{s}.
3267
3268@quotation
3269@c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3270@c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3271@c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3272@c distinction here.
3273@emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3274within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3275execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3276debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3277is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3278without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3279below.
3280@end quotation
3281
d4f3574e
SS
3282The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3283source line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
c906108c
SS
3284switch statements, for loops, etc. @code{step} continues to stop if a
3285function that has debugging information is called within the line.
d4f3574e
SS
3286In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions called
3287within the line.
c906108c 3288
d4f3574e
SS
3289Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3290number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5d161b24 3291@code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
c906108c 3292on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5d161b24 3293was any debugging information about the routine.
c906108c
SS
3294
3295@item step @var{count}
3296Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
7a292a7a
SS
3297breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3298@var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
c906108c
SS
3299
3300@kindex next
41afff9a 3301@kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
c906108c
SS
3302@item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3303Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
7a292a7a
SS
3304This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3305the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3306control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3307that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3308is abbreviated @code{n}.
c906108c
SS
3309
3310An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3311
3312
3313@c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3314@c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
3315@c
3316@c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3317@c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3318@c function are executed without stopping.
3319
d4f3574e
SS
3320The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3321source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5d161b24 3322switch statements, for loops, etc.
c906108c
SS
3323
3324@kindex finish
3325@item finish
3326Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
3327returns. Print the returned value (if any).
3328
3329Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
3330,Returning from a function}).
3331
3332@kindex until
41afff9a 3333@kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
c906108c
SS
3334@item until
3335@itemx u
3336Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
3337current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
3338stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
3339command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
3340automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
3341than the address of the jump.
3342
3343This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
3344though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
3345exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
3346simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
3347through the next iteration.
3348
3349@code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
3350stack frame.
3351
3352@code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
3353of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
3354example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
3355(@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
3356@code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
3357
3358@example
3359(@value{GDBP}) f
3360#0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
3361206 expand_input();
3362(@value{GDBP}) until
3363195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
3364@end example
3365
3366This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
3367generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
3368start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
3369written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
3370to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
3371expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
3372statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
3373
3374@code{until} with no argument works by means of single
3375instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
3376argument.
3377
3378@item until @var{location}
3379@itemx u @var{location}
3380Continue running your program until either the specified location is
3381reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
3382the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3383,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints,
3384and hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument.
3385
3386@kindex stepi
41afff9a 3387@kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
c906108c 3388@item stepi
96a2c332 3389@itemx stepi @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3390@itemx si
3391Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
3392
3393It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
3394instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
3395instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
3396Display,, Automatic display}.
3397
3398An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
3399
3400@need 750
3401@kindex nexti
41afff9a 3402@kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
c906108c 3403@item nexti
96a2c332 3404@itemx nexti @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3405@itemx ni
3406Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
3407proceed until the function returns.
3408
3409An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
3410@end table
3411
6d2ebf8b 3412@node Signals
c906108c
SS
3413@section Signals
3414@cindex signals
3415
3416A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
3417operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
3418kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
d4f3574e 3419signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{C-c});
c906108c
SS
3420@code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
3421memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
3422the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
3423requested an alarm).
3424
3425@cindex fatal signals
3426Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
3427functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
d4f3574e 3428errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
c906108c
SS
3429program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
3430@code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
3431fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
3432
3433@value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
3434program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
3435signal.
3436
3437@cindex handling signals
3438Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to ignore non-erroneous signals like @code{SIGALRM}
3439(so as not to interfere with their role in the functioning of your program)
3440but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
3441You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
3442
3443@table @code
3444@kindex info signals
3445@item info signals
96a2c332 3446@itemx info handle
c906108c
SS
3447Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
3448handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
3449the defined types of signals.
3450
d4f3574e 3451@code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
c906108c
SS
3452
3453@kindex handle
3454@item handle @var{signal} @var{keywords}@dots{}
5d161b24 3455Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can
c906108c
SS
3456be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the @samp{SIG} at the
3457beginning). The @var{keywords} say what change to make.
3458@end table
3459
3460@c @group
3461The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
3462Their full names are:
3463
3464@table @code
3465@item nostop
3466@value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
3467still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
3468
3469@item stop
3470@value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
3471the @code{print} keyword as well.
3472
3473@item print
3474@value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
3475
3476@item noprint
3477@value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
3478implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
3479
3480@item pass
3481@value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
3482can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
3483and not handled.
3484
3485@item nopass
3486@value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
3487@end table
3488@c @end group
3489
d4f3574e
SS
3490When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
3491program until you
c906108c
SS
3492continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
3493effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
3494after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
3495command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
3496program sees that signal when you continue.
3497
3498You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
3499seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
3500or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
3501due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
3502values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
3503execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
3504a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
3505you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5d161b24 3506program a signal}.
c906108c 3507
6d2ebf8b 3508@node Thread Stops
c906108c
SS
3509@section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3510
3511When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
3512programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
3513breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
3514
3515@table @code
3516@cindex breakpoints and threads
3517@cindex thread breakpoints
3518@kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
3519@item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
3520@itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
3521@var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
3522writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
3523
3524Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
3525to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
3526particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
3527numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
3528column of the @samp{info threads} display.
3529
3530If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
3531breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
3532program.
3533
3534You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
3535well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
3536breakpoint condition, like this:
3537
3538@smallexample
2df3850c 3539(@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
c906108c
SS
3540@end smallexample
3541
3542@end table
3543
3544@cindex stopped threads
3545@cindex threads, stopped
3546Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
3547@emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
3548allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
3549switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
3550underfoot.
3551
3552@cindex continuing threads
3553@cindex threads, continuing
3554Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
3555executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5d161b24 3556like @code{step} or @code{next}.
c906108c
SS
3557
3558In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
3559Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
3560system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
3561execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
3562single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
3563statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
3564stops.
3565
3566You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
3567continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
3568thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
3569first thread completes whatever you requested.
3570
3571On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
3572thread to run.
3573
3574@table @code
3575@item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
3576Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
3577locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
3578current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
3579mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
3580``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
3581stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
d4f3574e 3582when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
c906108c 3583function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
d4f3574e 3584like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
c906108c 3585thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
2df3850c 3586@value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
c906108c
SS
3587
3588@item show scheduler-locking
3589Display the current scheduler locking mode.
3590@end table
3591
c906108c 3592
6d2ebf8b 3593@node Stack
c906108c
SS
3594@chapter Examining the Stack
3595
3596When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
3597stopped and how it got there.
3598
3599@cindex call stack
5d161b24
DB
3600Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
3601is generated.
3602That information includes the location of the call in your program,
3603the arguments of the call,
c906108c 3604and the local variables of the function being called.
5d161b24 3605The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
c906108c
SS
3606The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
3607stack}.
3608
3609When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
3610stack allow you to see all of this information.
3611
3612@cindex selected frame
3613One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
3614@value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
3615particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
3616your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
3617special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
3618interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3619
3620When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
5d161b24 3621currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
c906108c
SS
3622@code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
3623
3624@menu
3625* Frames:: Stack frames
3626* Backtrace:: Backtraces
3627* Selection:: Selecting a frame
3628* Frame Info:: Information on a frame
c906108c
SS
3629
3630@end menu
3631
6d2ebf8b 3632@node Frames
c906108c
SS
3633@section Stack frames
3634
d4f3574e 3635@cindex frame, definition
c906108c
SS
3636@cindex stack frame
3637The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
3638frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
3639with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
3640to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
3641which the function is executing.
3642
3643@cindex initial frame
3644@cindex outermost frame
3645@cindex innermost frame
3646When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
3647function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
3648@dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
3649made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
3650is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
3651the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
3652actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
3653recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
3654
3655@cindex frame pointer
3656Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
3657stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
3658kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
3659address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
3660in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register} while execution is
3661going on in that frame.
3662
3663@cindex frame number
3664@value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
3665zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
3666and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
3667they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
3668frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
3669
6d2ebf8b
SS
3670@c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
3671@c underflow problems.
c906108c
SS
3672@cindex frameless execution
3673Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
6d2ebf8b
SS
3674without stack frames. (For example, the @value{GCC} option
3675@example
3676@samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
3677@end example
3678generates functions without a frame.)
c906108c
SS
3679This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
3680the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
3681with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
3682has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
3683it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
3684correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
3685no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
3686
3687@table @code
d4f3574e 3688@kindex frame@r{, command}
41afff9a 3689@cindex current stack frame
c906108c 3690@item frame @var{args}
5d161b24 3691The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
c906108c 3692and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
5d161b24
DB
3693address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
3694@code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
c906108c
SS
3695
3696@kindex select-frame
41afff9a 3697@cindex selecting frame silently
c906108c
SS
3698@item select-frame
3699The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
3700to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
3701@code{frame}.
3702@end table
3703
6d2ebf8b 3704@node Backtrace
c906108c
SS
3705@section Backtraces
3706
3707@cindex backtraces
3708@cindex tracebacks
3709@cindex stack traces
3710A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
3711line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
3712frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
3713stack.
3714
3715@table @code
3716@kindex backtrace
41afff9a 3717@kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
c906108c
SS
3718@item backtrace
3719@itemx bt
3720Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
3721frames in the stack.
3722
3723You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
3724character, normally @kbd{C-c}.
3725
3726@item backtrace @var{n}
3727@itemx bt @var{n}
3728Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
3729
3730@item backtrace -@var{n}
3731@itemx bt -@var{n}
3732Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
3733@end table
3734
3735@kindex where
3736@kindex info stack
41afff9a 3737@kindex info s @r{(@code{info stack})}
c906108c
SS
3738The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
3739are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
3740
3741Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
3742The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
3743print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
3744line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
3745counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
3746line number.
3747
3748Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
3749@samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
3750
3751@smallexample
3752@group
5d161b24 3753#0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
c906108c
SS
3754 at builtin.c:993
3755#1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
3756#2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
3757 at macro.c:71
3758(More stack frames follow...)
3759@end group
3760@end smallexample
3761
3762@noindent
3763The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
3764value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
3765code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
3766
6d2ebf8b 3767@node Selection
c906108c
SS
3768@section Selecting a frame
3769
3770Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
3771whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
3772selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
3773of the stack frame just selected.
3774
3775@table @code
d4f3574e 3776@kindex frame@r{, selecting}
41afff9a 3777@kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
c906108c
SS
3778@item frame @var{n}
3779@itemx f @var{n}
3780Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
3781(currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
3782innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
3783@code{main}.
3784
3785@item frame @var{addr}
3786@itemx f @var{addr}
3787Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
3788chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
3789impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
3790addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
3791switches between them.
3792
c906108c
SS
3793On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
3794select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
3795
3796On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
3797pointer and a program counter.
3798
3799On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
3800pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
3801@c note to future updaters: this is conditioned on a flag
3802@c SETUP_ARBITRARY_FRAME in the tm-*.h files. The above is up to date
3803@c as of 27 Jan 1994.
c906108c
SS
3804
3805@kindex up
3806@item up @var{n}
3807Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3808advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
3809that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
3810
3811@kindex down
41afff9a 3812@kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
c906108c
SS
3813@item down @var{n}
3814Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3815advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
3816that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
3817abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
3818@end table
3819
3820All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
3821frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
3822arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
5d161b24 3823frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
c906108c
SS
3824
3825@need 1000
3826For example:
3827
3828@smallexample
3829@group
3830(@value{GDBP}) up
3831#1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
3832 at env.c:10
383310 read_input_file (argv[i]);
3834@end group
3835@end smallexample
3836
3837After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
3838prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
3839@xref{List, ,Printing source lines}.
3840
3841@table @code
3842@kindex down-silently
3843@kindex up-silently
3844@item up-silently @var{n}
3845@itemx down-silently @var{n}
3846These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
3847respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
3848causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
3849in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
3850distracting.
3851@end table
3852
6d2ebf8b 3853@node Frame Info
c906108c
SS
3854@section Information about a frame
3855
3856There are several other commands to print information about the selected
3857stack frame.
3858
3859@table @code
3860@item frame
3861@itemx f
3862When used without any argument, this command does not change which
3863frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
3864selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
3865argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
3866@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3867
3868@kindex info frame
41afff9a 3869@kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
c906108c
SS
3870@item info frame
3871@itemx info f
3872This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
3873including:
3874
3875@itemize @bullet
5d161b24
DB
3876@item
3877the address of the frame
c906108c
SS
3878@item
3879the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
3880@item
3881the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
3882@item
3883the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
3884@item
3885the address of the frame's arguments
3886@item
d4f3574e
SS
3887the address of the frame's local variables
3888@item
c906108c
SS
3889the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
3890@item
3891which registers were saved in the frame
3892@end itemize
3893
3894@noindent The verbose description is useful when
3895something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
3896the usual conventions.
3897
3898@item info frame @var{addr}
3899@itemx info f @var{addr}
3900Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
3901selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
3902command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
3903architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
3904@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3905
3906@kindex info args
3907@item info args
3908Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
3909
3910@item info locals
3911@kindex info locals
3912Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
3913line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
3914accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
3915
c906108c 3916@kindex info catch
d4f3574e
SS
3917@cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
3918@cindex exception handlers, how to list
c906108c
SS
3919@item info catch
3920Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
3921current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
3922exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
3923@code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
3924@xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
53a5351d 3925
c906108c
SS
3926@end table
3927
c906108c 3928
6d2ebf8b 3929@node Source
c906108c
SS
3930@chapter Examining Source Files
3931
3932@value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
3933information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
3934used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
3935the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
3936(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
3937execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
3938source files by explicit command.
3939
7a292a7a 3940If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
d4f3574e 3941prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7a292a7a 3942@value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
c906108c
SS
3943
3944@menu
3945* List:: Printing source lines
c906108c 3946* Search:: Searching source files
c906108c
SS
3947* Source Path:: Specifying source directories
3948* Machine Code:: Source and machine code
3949@end menu
3950
6d2ebf8b 3951@node List
c906108c
SS
3952@section Printing source lines
3953
3954@kindex list
41afff9a 3955@kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
c906108c 3956To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
5d161b24 3957(abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
c906108c
SS
3958There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
3959
3960Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
3961
3962@table @code
3963@item list @var{linenum}
3964Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
3965current source file.
3966
3967@item list @var{function}
3968Print lines centered around the beginning of function
3969@var{function}.
3970
3971@item list
3972Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
3973@code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
3974printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
3975as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
3976Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
3977
3978@item list -
3979Print lines just before the lines last printed.
3980@end table
3981
3982By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
3983the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
3984
3985@table @code
3986@kindex set listsize
3987@item set listsize @var{count}
3988Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
3989the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
3990
3991@kindex show listsize
3992@item show listsize
3993Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
3994@end table
3995
3996Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
3997so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
3998than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
3999argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4000each repetition moves up in the source file.
4001
4002@cindex linespec
4003In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4004@dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
d4f3574e 4005of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
c906108c
SS
4006Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4007
4008@table @code
4009@item list @var{linespec}
4010Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4011
4012@item list @var{first},@var{last}
4013Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4014linespecs.
4015
4016@item list ,@var{last}
4017Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4018
4019@item list @var{first},
4020Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4021
4022@item list +
4023Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4024
4025@item list -
4026Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4027
4028@item list
4029As described in the preceding table.
4030@end table
4031
4032Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4033kinds of linespec.
4034
4035@table @code
4036@item @var{number}
4037Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4038When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4039the same source file as the first linespec.
4040
4041@item +@var{offset}
4042Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4043When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4044two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4045first linespec.
4046
4047@item -@var{offset}
4048Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4049
4050@item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4051Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4052
4053@item @var{function}
4054Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4055For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4056
4057@item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4058Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4059function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4060file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4061identically named functions in different source files.
4062
4063@item *@var{address}
4064Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4065@var{address} may be any expression.
4066@end table
4067
6d2ebf8b 4068@node Search
c906108c
SS
4069@section Searching source files
4070@cindex searching
4071@kindex reverse-search
4072
4073There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
4074regular expression.
4075
4076@table @code
4077@kindex search
4078@kindex forward-search
4079@item forward-search @var{regexp}
4080@itemx search @var{regexp}
4081The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
4082starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5d161b24 4083@var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
c906108c
SS
4084synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
4085@code{fo}.
4086
4087@item reverse-search @var{regexp}
4088The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
4089with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
4090for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
4091this command as @code{rev}.
4092@end table
c906108c 4093
6d2ebf8b 4094@node Source Path
c906108c
SS
4095@section Specifying source directories
4096
4097@cindex source path
4098@cindex directories for source files
4099Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
4100files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
4101the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
4102session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
4103this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
4104it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
4105in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name. Note that
4106the executable search path is @emph{not} used for this purpose. Neither is
4107the current working directory, unless it happens to be in the source
4108path.
4109
4110If @value{GDBN} cannot find a source file in the source path, and the
4111object program records a directory, @value{GDBN} tries that directory
4112too. If the source path is empty, and there is no record of the
4113compilation directory, @value{GDBN} looks in the current directory as a
4114last resort.
4115
4116Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
4117any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
4118each line is in the file.
4119
4120@kindex directory
4121@kindex dir
d4f3574e
SS
4122When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
4123and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
c906108c
SS
4124To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
4125
4126@table @code
4127@item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
4128@item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
4129Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
d4f3574e
SS
4130directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
4131(@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
4132part of absolute file names) or
c906108c
SS
4133whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
4134path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
4135
4136@kindex cdir
4137@kindex cwd
41afff9a
EZ
4138@vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
4139@vindex $cwdr@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
4140@cindex compilation directory
4141@cindex current directory
4142@cindex working directory
4143@cindex directory, current
4144@cindex directory, compilation
4145You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
4146directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
4147working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
4148tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
4149session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
4150directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
4151
4152@item directory
4153Reset the source path to empty again. This requires confirmation.
4154
4155@c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
4156@c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
4157
4158@item show directories
4159@kindex show directories
4160Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
4161@end table
4162
4163If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
4164interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
4165versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
4166
4167@enumerate
4168@item
4169Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to empty.
4170
4171@item
4172Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
4173directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
4174directories in one command.
4175@end enumerate
4176
6d2ebf8b 4177@node Machine Code
c906108c
SS
4178@section Source and machine code
4179
4180You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
4181addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
4182a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
d4f3574e 4183mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5d161b24 4184line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
c906108c
SS
4185well as hex.
4186
4187@table @code
4188@kindex info line
4189@item info line @var{linespec}
4190Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
4191source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
4192the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
4193source lines}).
4194@end table
4195
4196For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
4197the object code for the first line of function
4198@code{m4_changequote}:
4199
d4f3574e
SS
4200@c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
4201@c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
c906108c 4202@smallexample
96a2c332 4203(@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
c906108c
SS
4204Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
4205@end smallexample
4206
4207@noindent
4208We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
4209@var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
4210@smallexample
4211(@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
4212Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
4213@end smallexample
4214
4215@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
41afff9a 4216@kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
c906108c
SS
4217After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
4218is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
4219sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
4220,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
4221convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4222variables}).
4223
4224@table @code
4225@kindex disassemble
4226@cindex assembly instructions
4227@cindex instructions, assembly
4228@cindex machine instructions
4229@cindex listing machine instructions
4230@item disassemble
4231This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
4232instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
4233program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
4234command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
4235surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
4236(first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
4237@end table
4238
c906108c
SS
4239The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
4240HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
4241
4242@smallexample
4243(@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
4244Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
42450x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
42460x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
42470x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
42480x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
42490x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
42500x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
42510x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
42520x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4253End of assembler dump.
4254@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4255
4256Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
4257mnemonics or other syntax.
4258
4259@table @code
d4f3574e 4260@kindex set disassembly-flavor
c906108c
SS
4261@cindex assembly instructions
4262@cindex instructions, assembly
4263@cindex machine instructions
4264@cindex listing machine instructions
d4f3574e
SS
4265@cindex Intel disassembly flavor
4266@cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
4267@item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
c906108c
SS
4268Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
4269program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
4270
4271Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
d4f3574e
SS
4272can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
4273The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
4274assemblers for x86-based targets.
c906108c
SS
4275@end table
4276
4277
6d2ebf8b 4278@node Data
c906108c
SS
4279@chapter Examining Data
4280
4281@cindex printing data
4282@cindex examining data
4283@kindex print
4284@kindex inspect
4285@c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
4286@c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
4287@c different window or something like that.
4288The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
7a292a7a
SS
4289command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
4290evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
4291program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
4292Different Languages}).
c906108c
SS
4293
4294@table @code
d4f3574e
SS
4295@item print @var{expr}
4296@itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
4297@var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
4298value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
c906108c 4299you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
d4f3574e 4300@var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
c906108c
SS
4301formats}.
4302
4303@item print
4304@itemx print /@var{f}
d4f3574e 4305If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
c906108c
SS
4306@dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
4307conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
4308@end table
4309
4310A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
4311It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
4312specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4313
7a292a7a 4314If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
d4f3574e
SS
4315fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
4316command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
7a292a7a 4317Table}.
c906108c
SS
4318
4319@menu
4320* Expressions:: Expressions
4321* Variables:: Program variables
4322* Arrays:: Artificial arrays
4323* Output Formats:: Output formats
4324* Memory:: Examining memory
4325* Auto Display:: Automatic display
4326* Print Settings:: Print settings
4327* Value History:: Value history
4328* Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
4329* Registers:: Registers
c906108c 4330* Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
c906108c
SS
4331@end menu
4332
6d2ebf8b 4333@node Expressions
c906108c
SS
4334@section Expressions
4335
4336@cindex expressions
4337@code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
4338compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
4339by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
4340@value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls, casts
4341and string constants. It unfortunately does not include symbols defined
4342by preprocessor @code{#define} commands.
4343
d4f3574e
SS
4344@value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
4345the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5d161b24 4346you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
d4f3574e 4347memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
c906108c 4348
c906108c
SS
4349Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
4350this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
4351Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
4352languages.
4353
4354In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
4355expressions regardless of your programming language.
4356
4357Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
4358useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
4359at that address in memory.
4360@c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
c906108c
SS
4361
4362@value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
4363to programming languages:
4364
4365@table @code
4366@item @@
4367@samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
4368@xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
4369
4370@item ::
4371@samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
4372function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
4373
4374@cindex @{@var{type}@}
4375@cindex type casting memory
4376@cindex memory, viewing as typed object
4377@cindex casts, to view memory
4378@item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
4379Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
4380memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
4381pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
4382a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
4383normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
4384@end table
4385
6d2ebf8b 4386@node Variables
c906108c
SS
4387@section Program variables
4388
4389The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
4390in your program.
4391
4392Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
4393(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
4394
4395@itemize @bullet
4396@item
4397global (or file-static)
4398@end itemize
4399
5d161b24 4400@noindent or
c906108c
SS
4401
4402@itemize @bullet
4403@item
4404visible according to the scope rules of the
4405programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5d161b24 4406@end itemize
c906108c
SS
4407
4408@noindent This means that in the function
4409
4410@example
4411foo (a)
4412 int a;
4413@{
4414 bar (a);
4415 @{
4416 int b = test ();
4417 bar (b);
4418 @}
4419@}
4420@end example
4421
4422@noindent
4423you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
4424executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
4425examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
4426the block where @code{b} is declared.
4427
4428@cindex variable name conflict
4429There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
4430scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
4431in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
4432function with the same name (in different source files). If that
4433happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
4434you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
4435using the colon-colon notation:
4436
d4f3574e 4437@cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
c906108c
SS
4438@iftex
4439@c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
41afff9a 4440@cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
c906108c
SS
4441@end iftex
4442@example
4443@var{file}::@var{variable}
4444@var{function}::@var{variable}
4445@end example
4446
4447@noindent
4448Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
4449static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
4450make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
4451to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
4452
4453@example
4454(@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
4455@end example
4456
c906108c
SS
4457@cindex C++ scope resolution
4458This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
4459use of the same notation in C++. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C++
4460scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
4461@c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
4462@c conflict?? --mew
c906108c
SS
4463
4464@cindex wrong values
4465@cindex variable values, wrong
4466@quotation
4467@emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
4468wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
4469scope, and just before exit.
4470@end quotation
4471You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
4472This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
4473set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
4474stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
4475values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
4476also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
4477after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
4478variable definitions may be gone.
4479
4480This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
4481To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
4482when compiling.
4483
d4f3574e
SS
4484@cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
4485Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
4486unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
4487opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
4488offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
4489might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
4490happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
4491
4492@example
4493No symbol "foo" in current context.
4494@end example
4495
4496To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
4497different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
4498formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C++ compiler usually
4499supports the @samp{-gstabs} option. @samp{-gstabs} produces debug info
4500in a format that is superior to formats such as COFF. You may be able
4501to use DWARF-2 (@samp{-gdwarf-2}), which is also an effective form for
4502debug info. See @ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your
4503Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more
4504information.
4505
4506
6d2ebf8b 4507@node Arrays
c906108c
SS
4508@section Artificial arrays
4509
4510@cindex artificial array
41afff9a 4511@kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
c906108c
SS
4512It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
4513same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
4514dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
4515program.
4516
4517You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
4518@dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
4519operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
4520and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
4521of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
4522the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
4523argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
4524following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
4525example. If a program says
4526
4527@example
4528int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
4529@end example
4530
4531@noindent
4532you can print the contents of @code{array} with
4533
4534@example
4535p *array@@len
4536@end example
4537
4538The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
4539with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
4540subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
4541Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
4542(@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
4543
4544Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
4545This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
4546The value need not be in memory:
4547@example
4548(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
4549$1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4550@end example
4551
4552As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
c3f6f71d 4553@samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
c906108c
SS
4554the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
4555@example
4556(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
4557$2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4558@end example
4559
4560Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
4561moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
4562actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
4563of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
4564to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4565variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
4566interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
4567instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
4568structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
4569in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
4570
4571@example
4572set $i = 0
4573p dtab[$i++]->fv
4574@key{RET}
4575@key{RET}
4576@dots{}
4577@end example
4578
6d2ebf8b 4579@node Output Formats
c906108c
SS
4580@section Output formats
4581
4582@cindex formatted output
4583@cindex output formats
4584By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
4585this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
4586in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
4587at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
4588these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
4589
4590The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
4591already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
4592@code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
4593letters supported are:
4594
4595@table @code
4596@item x
4597Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
4598hexadecimal.
4599
4600@item d
4601Print as integer in signed decimal.
4602
4603@item u
4604Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
4605
4606@item o
4607Print as integer in octal.
4608
4609@item t
4610Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
4611@footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
4612used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
d4f3574e 4613see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
c906108c
SS
4614
4615@item a
4616@cindex unknown address, locating
4617Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
4618the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
4619where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
4620
4621@example
4622(@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
4623$3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
4624@end example
4625
4626@item c
4627Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant.
4628
4629@item f
4630Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
4631using typical floating point syntax.
4632@end table
4633
4634For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
4635
4636@example
4637p/x $pc
4638@end example
4639
4640@noindent
4641Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
4642names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
4643
4644To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
4645you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
4646expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
4647
6d2ebf8b 4648@node Memory
c906108c
SS
4649@section Examining memory
4650
4651You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
4652any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
4653
4654@cindex examining memory
4655@table @code
41afff9a 4656@kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
c906108c
SS
4657@item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
4658@itemx x @var{addr}
4659@itemx x
4660Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
4661@end table
4662
4663@var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
4664much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
4665expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
4666If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
4667Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
4668
4669@table @r
4670@item @var{n}, the repeat count
4671The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
4672how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
4673@c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
4674@c 4.1.2.
4675
4676@item @var{f}, the display format
4677The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print},
4678@samp{s} (null-terminated string), or @samp{i} (machine instruction).
4679The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially.
4680The default changes each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
4681
4682@item @var{u}, the unit size
4683The unit size is any of
4684
4685@table @code
4686@item b
4687Bytes.
4688@item h
4689Halfwords (two bytes).
4690@item w
4691Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
4692@item g
4693Giant words (eight bytes).
4694@end table
4695
4696Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
4697default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
4698@samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
4699
4700@item @var{addr}, starting display address
4701@var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
4702memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
4703it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
4704@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
4705@var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
4706other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
4707the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
4708starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
4709a value from memory).
4710@end table
4711
4712For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
4713(@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
4714starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
4715words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
d4f3574e 4716@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
c906108c
SS
4717
4718Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
4719letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
4720unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
4721specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
4722(However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
4723
4724Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
4725and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
4726@samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
4727including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
d4f3574e 4728alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
c906108c
SS
4729Code,,Source and machine code}.
4730
4731All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
4732easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
4733you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
4734instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
4735with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
4736the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
4737for successive uses of @code{x}.
4738
4739@cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
4740The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
4741in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
4742would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
4743subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
4744@code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
4745examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
4746@code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
4747the convenience variable @code{$__}.
4748
4749If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
4750are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
4751address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
4752
6d2ebf8b 4753@node Auto Display
c906108c
SS
4754@section Automatic display
4755@cindex automatic display
4756@cindex display of expressions
4757
4758If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
4759(to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
4760display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
4761Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
4762to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
4763The automatic display looks like this:
4764
4765@example
47662: foo = 38
47673: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
4768@end example
4769
4770@noindent
4771This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
4772displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
4773specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
4774whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
4775format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
4776or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
4777supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
4778
4779@table @code
4780@kindex display
d4f3574e
SS
4781@item display @var{expr}
4782Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
c906108c
SS
4783each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4784
4785@code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
4786
d4f3574e 4787@item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
c906108c 4788For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
d4f3574e 4789count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
c906108c
SS
4790arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
4791@xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
4792
4793@item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
4794For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
4795number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
4796be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
4797doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4798@end table
4799
4800For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
4801instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
d4f3574e 4802is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
4803
4804@table @code
4805@kindex delete display
4806@kindex undisplay
4807@item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
4808@itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4809Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
4810
4811@code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
4812(Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
4813
4814@kindex disable display
4815@item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4816Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
4817item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
4818enabled again later.
4819
4820@kindex enable display
4821@item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4822Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
4823again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
4824
4825@item display
4826Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
4827done when your program stops.
4828
4829@kindex info display
4830@item info display
4831Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
4832automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
4833values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
4834It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
4835because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
4836@end table
4837
4838If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
4839sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
4840expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
4841variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
4842@code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
4843@code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
4844continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
4845there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
4846automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
4847is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
4848
6d2ebf8b 4849@node Print Settings
c906108c
SS
4850@section Print settings
4851
4852@cindex format options
4853@cindex print settings
4854@value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
4855and symbols are printed.
4856
4857@noindent
4858These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
4859
4860@table @code
4861@kindex set print address
4862@item set print address
4863@itemx set print address on
4864@value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
4865traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
4866even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
4867is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
4868@code{set print address on}:
4869
4870@smallexample
4871@group
4872(@value{GDBP}) f
4873#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
4874 at input.c:530
4875530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
4876@end group
4877@end smallexample
4878
4879@item set print address off
4880Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
4881this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
4882
4883@smallexample
4884@group
4885(@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
4886(@value{GDBP}) f
4887#0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
4888530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
4889@end group
4890@end smallexample
4891
4892You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
4893dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
4894@code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
4895all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
4896
4897@kindex show print address
4898@item show print address
4899Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
4900@end table
4901
4902When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
4903closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
4904identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
4905source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
4906@code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
4907you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
4908it prints a symbolic address:
4909
4910@table @code
4911@kindex set print symbol-filename
4912@item set print symbol-filename on
4913Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
4914symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
4915
4916@item set print symbol-filename off
4917Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
4918default.
4919
4920@kindex show print symbol-filename
4921@item show print symbol-filename
4922Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
4923line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
4924@end table
4925
4926Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
4927numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
4928number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
4929
4930Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
4931printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
4932
4933@table @code
4934@kindex set print max-symbolic-offset
4935@item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
4936Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
4937offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
5d161b24 4938@var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
4939to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
4940
4941@kindex show print max-symbolic-offset
4942@item show print max-symbolic-offset
4943Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
4944symbolic address.
4945@end table
4946
4947@cindex wild pointer, interpreting
4948@cindex pointer, finding referent
4949If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
4950@samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
4951and source file location of the variable where it points, using
4952@samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
4953For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
4954at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
4955
4956@example
4957(@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
4958(@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
4959$4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
4960@end example
4961
4962@quotation
4963@emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
4964does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
4965the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
4966@end quotation
4967
4968Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
4969
4970@table @code
4971@kindex set print array
4972@item set print array
4973@itemx set print array on
4974Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
4975but uses more space. The default is off.
4976
4977@item set print array off
4978Return to compressed format for arrays.
4979
4980@kindex show print array
4981@item show print array
4982Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
4983arrays.
4984
4985@kindex set print elements
4986@item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
4987Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
4988If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
4989printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
4990This limit also applies to the display of strings.
d4f3574e 4991When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
c906108c
SS
4992Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
4993
4994@kindex show print elements
4995@item show print elements
4996Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
4997If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
4998
4999@kindex set print null-stop
5000@item set print null-stop
5001Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
d4f3574e 5002@sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
c906108c 5003contain only short strings.
d4f3574e 5004The default is off.
c906108c
SS
5005
5006@kindex set print pretty
5007@item set print pretty on
5d161b24 5008Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
c906108c
SS
5009per line, like this:
5010
5011@smallexample
5012@group
5013$1 = @{
5014 next = 0x0,
5015 flags = @{
5016 sweet = 1,
5017 sour = 1
5018 @},
5019 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
5020@}
5021@end group
5022@end smallexample
5023
5024@item set print pretty off
5025Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
5026
5027@smallexample
5028@group
5029$1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
5030meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
5031@end group
5032@end smallexample
5033
5034@noindent
5035This is the default format.
5036
5037@kindex show print pretty
5038@item show print pretty
5039Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
5040
5041@kindex set print sevenbit-strings
5042@item set print sevenbit-strings on
5043Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
5044@value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
5045character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
5046best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
5047high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
5048
5049@item set print sevenbit-strings off
5050Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
5051international character sets, and is the default.
5052
5053@kindex show print sevenbit-strings
5054@item show print sevenbit-strings
5055Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
5056
5057@kindex set print union
5058@item set print union on
5d161b24 5059Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures. This
c906108c
SS
5060is the default setting.
5061
5062@item set print union off
5063Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in structures.
5064
5065@kindex show print union
5066@item show print union
5067Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
5068structures.
5069
5070For example, given the declarations
5071
5072@smallexample
5073typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
5074typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
5d161b24 5075typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
c906108c
SS
5076 Bug_forms;
5077
5078struct thing @{
5079 Species it;
5080 union @{
5081 Tree_forms tree;
5082 Bug_forms bug;
5083 @} form;
5084@};
5085
5086struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
5087@end smallexample
5088
5089@noindent
5090with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
5091
5092@smallexample
5093$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
5094@end smallexample
5095
5096@noindent
5097and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
5098
5099@smallexample
5100$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
5101@end smallexample
5102@end table
5103
c906108c
SS
5104@need 1000
5105@noindent
5106These settings are of interest when debugging C++ programs:
5107
5108@table @code
5109@cindex demangling
5110@kindex set print demangle
5111@item set print demangle
5112@itemx set print demangle on
5113Print C++ names in their source form rather than in the encoded
5114(``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
d4f3574e 5115linkage. The default is on.
c906108c
SS
5116
5117@kindex show print demangle
5118@item show print demangle
5119Show whether C++ names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
5120
5121@kindex set print asm-demangle
5122@item set print asm-demangle
5123@itemx set print asm-demangle on
5124Print C++ names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
5125in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
5126The default is off.
5127
5128@kindex show print asm-demangle
5129@item show print asm-demangle
5130Show whether C++ names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
5131or demangled form.
5132
5133@kindex set demangle-style
5134@cindex C++ symbol decoding style
5135@cindex symbol decoding style, C++
5136@item set demangle-style @var{style}
5137Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
5138represent C++ names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
5139
5140@table @code
5141@item auto
5142Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
5143
5144@item gnu
5d161b24 5145Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C++ compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c 5146This is the default.
c906108c
SS
5147
5148@item hp
5149Decode based on the HP ANSI C++ (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
5150
5151@item lucid
5152Decode based on the Lucid C++ compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
5153
5154@item arm
5155Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C++ Annotated Reference Manual}.
5156@strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
5157debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
5158require further enhancement to permit that.
5159
5160@end table
5161If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
5162
5163@kindex show demangle-style
5164@item show demangle-style
5165Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C++ symbols.
5166
5167@kindex set print object
5168@item set print object
5169@itemx set print object on
5170When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
5171(derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
5172the virtual function table.
5173
5174@item set print object off
5175Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
5176virtual function table. This is the default setting.
5177
5178@kindex show print object
5179@item show print object
5180Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
5181
5182@kindex set print static-members
5183@item set print static-members
5184@itemx set print static-members on
5185Print static members when displaying a C++ object. The default is on.
5186
5187@item set print static-members off
5188Do not print static members when displaying a C++ object.
5189
5190@kindex show print static-members
5191@item show print static-members
5192Show whether C++ static members are printed, or not.
5193
5194@c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
5195@kindex set print vtbl
5196@item set print vtbl
5197@itemx set print vtbl on
5198Pretty print C++ virtual function tables. The default is off.
c906108c
SS
5199(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
5200ANSI C++ compiler (@code{aCC}).)
c906108c
SS
5201
5202@item set print vtbl off
5203Do not pretty print C++ virtual function tables.
5204
5205@kindex show print vtbl
5206@item show print vtbl
5207Show whether C++ virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
5208@end table
c906108c 5209
6d2ebf8b 5210@node Value History
c906108c
SS
5211@section Value history
5212
5213@cindex value history
5d161b24
DB
5214Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
5215@dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
5216Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
5217(for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
5218When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
5219since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
c906108c
SS
5220symbol table.
5221
5222@cindex @code{$}
5223@cindex @code{$$}
5224@cindex history number
5225The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
5226refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
5227@code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
5228printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
5229history number.
5230
5231To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
5232history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
5233remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
5234the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
5235@code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
5236is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
5237@code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
5238
5239For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
5240want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
5241
5242@example
5243p *$
5244@end example
5245
5246If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
5247to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
5248
5249@example
5250p *$.next
5251@end example
5252
5253@noindent
5254You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
5255command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
5256
5257Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
5258@code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
5259
5260@example
5261print x
5262set x=5
5263@end example
5264
5265@noindent
5266then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
5267remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
5268
5269@table @code
5270@kindex show values
5271@item show values
5272Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
5273This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
5274values} does not change the history.
5275
5276@item show values @var{n}
5277Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
5278
5279@item show values +
5280Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
5281values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
5282@end table
5283
5284Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
5285same effect as @samp{show values +}.
5286
6d2ebf8b 5287@node Convenience Vars
c906108c
SS
5288@section Convenience variables
5289
5290@cindex convenience variables
5291@value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
5292@value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
5293exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
5294setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
5295of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
5296
5297Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
5298@samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
d4f3574e 5299the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
5300(Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
5301by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
5302
5303You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
5304expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
5305For example:
5306
5307@example
5308set $foo = *object_ptr
5309@end example
5310
5311@noindent
5312would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
5313@code{object_ptr}.
5314
5315Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
5316value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
5317value with another assignment at any time.
5318
5319Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
5320variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
5321that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
5322variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
5323
5324@table @code
5325@kindex show convenience
5326@item show convenience
5327Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
d4f3574e 5328Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
c906108c
SS
5329@end table
5330
5331One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
5332incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
5333a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
5334
5335@example
5336set $i = 0
5337print bar[$i++]->contents
5338@end example
5339
d4f3574e
SS
5340@noindent
5341Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
c906108c
SS
5342
5343Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
5344values likely to be useful.
5345
5346@table @code
41afff9a 5347@vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5348@item $_
5349The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
5350the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
5351commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
5352set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
5353and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
5354except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
5355to the type of @code{$__}.
5356
41afff9a 5357@vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5358@item $__
5359The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
5360to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
5361to match the format in which the data was printed.
5362
5363@item $_exitcode
41afff9a 5364@vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5365The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
5366the program being debugged terminates.
5367@end table
5368
53a5351d
JM
5369On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
5370begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
5371name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
c906108c 5372
6d2ebf8b 5373@node Registers
c906108c
SS
5374@section Registers
5375
5376@cindex registers
5377You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
5378with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
5379for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
5380your machine.
5381
5382@table @code
5383@kindex info registers
5384@item info registers
5385Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
5386registers (in the selected stack frame).
5387
5388@kindex info all-registers
5389@cindex floating point registers
5390@item info all-registers
5391Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
5392registers.
5393
5394@item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
5395Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
5d161b24
DB
5396As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
5397the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
c906108c
SS
5398the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
5399@end table
5400
5401@value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
5402expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
5403architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
5404@code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
5405the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
5406pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
5407register that contains the processor status. For example,
5408you could print the program counter in hex with
5409
5410@example
5411p/x $pc
5412@end example
5413
5414@noindent
5415or print the instruction to be executed next with
5416
5417@example
5418x/i $pc
5419@end example
5420
5421@noindent
5422or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
5423one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
5424memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
5425stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
5426stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
5427regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
d4f3574e 5428see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
c906108c
SS
5429
5430@example
5431set $sp += 4
5432@end example
5433
5434Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
5435your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
5436so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
5437shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
5438registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
d4f3574e
SS
5439can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
5440is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
c906108c
SS
5441
5442@value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
5443integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
5444special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
5445registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
5446to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
5447(although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
5448@samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
5449
5450Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
5451means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
5452the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
5453sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
5454coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
5455programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
5d161b24 5456cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
c906108c
SS
5457that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
5458prints the data in both formats.
5459
5460Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
5461(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
5462value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
5463were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
5464true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
5465frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
5466
5467However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
5468code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
5469@value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
5470frame makes no difference.
5471
6d2ebf8b 5472@node Floating Point Hardware
c906108c
SS
5473@section Floating point hardware
5474@cindex floating point
5475
5476Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
5477you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
5478
5479@table @code
5480@kindex info float
5481@item info float
5482Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
5483point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
5484floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
5485the ARM and x86 machines.
5486@end table
c906108c 5487
6d2ebf8b 5488@node Languages
c906108c
SS
5489@chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
5490@cindex languages
5491
c906108c
SS
5492Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
5493rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
5494dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
5495Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
5d161b24 5496represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
c906108c 5497@samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
c906108c
SS
5498
5499@cindex working language
5500Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
5501allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
5502native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
5503consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
5504language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
5505language}.
5506
5507@menu
5508* Setting:: Switching between source languages
5509* Show:: Displaying the language
c906108c 5510* Checks:: Type and range checks
c906108c
SS
5511* Support:: Supported languages
5512@end menu
5513
6d2ebf8b 5514@node Setting
c906108c
SS
5515@section Switching between source languages
5516
5517There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
5518set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
5519@code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
5520defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
5521used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
5522are printed, etc.
5523
5524In addition to the working language, every source file that
5525@value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
5526file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
5527source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
5528language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
5529controls whether C++ names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
5530show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
d4f3574e
SS
5531set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
5532set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
5533Displaying the language}.
c906108c
SS
5534
5535This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
5d161b24 5536as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
c906108c
SS
5537another language. In that case, make the
5538program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
5539@value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
5540program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
5541
5542@menu
5543* Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
5544* Manually:: Setting the working language manually
5545* Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
5546@end menu
5547
6d2ebf8b 5548@node Filenames
c906108c
SS
5549@subsection List of filename extensions and languages
5550
5551If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
5552@value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
5553
5554@table @file
5555
5556@item .c
5557C source file
5558
5559@item .C
5560@itemx .cc
5561@itemx .cp
5562@itemx .cpp
5563@itemx .cxx
5564@itemx .c++
5565C++ source file
5566
5567@item .f
5568@itemx .F
5569Fortran source file
5570
c906108c
SS
5571@item .ch
5572@itemx .c186
5573@itemx .c286
96a2c332 5574CHILL source file
c906108c 5575
c906108c
SS
5576@item .mod
5577Modula-2 source file
c906108c
SS
5578
5579@item .s
5580@itemx .S
5581Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
5582@value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
5583@end table
5584
5585In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
5586extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
5587
6d2ebf8b 5588@node Manually
c906108c
SS
5589@subsection Setting the working language
5590
5591If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
5592expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
5593your program.
5594
5595@kindex set language
5596If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
5597command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
5d161b24 5598a language, such as
c906108c 5599@code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
c906108c
SS
5600For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
5601
c906108c
SS
5602Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
5603language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
5604to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
5605source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
5606languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
5607source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
5608command such as:
5609
5610@example
5611print a = b + c
5612@end example
5613
5614@noindent
5615might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
5616@code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
5617printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
5618@code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
c906108c 5619
6d2ebf8b 5620@node Automatically
c906108c
SS
5621@subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
5622
5623To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
5624@samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
5625then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
5626frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
5627working language to the language recorded for the function in that
5628frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
5629or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
5630does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
5631not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
5632
5633This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
5634entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
5635written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
5636a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
5637case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
5638
6d2ebf8b 5639@node Show
c906108c 5640@section Displaying the language
c906108c
SS
5641
5642The following commands help you find out which language is the
5643working language, and also what language source files were written in.
5644
5645@kindex show language
d4f3574e
SS
5646@kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
5647@kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
c906108c
SS
5648@table @code
5649@item show language
5650Display the current working language. This is the
5651language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
5652build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
5653
5654@item info frame
5d161b24 5655Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
c906108c 5656working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
5d161b24 5657@xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
c906108c
SS
5658information listed here.
5659
5660@item info source
5661Display the source language of this source file.
5d161b24 5662@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
c906108c
SS
5663information listed here.
5664@end table
5665
5666In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
5667not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
5668with a language explicitly:
5669
5670@kindex set extension-language
5671@kindex info extensions
5672@table @code
5673@item set extension-language @var{.ext} @var{language}
5674Set source files with extension @var{.ext} to be assumed to be in
5675the source language @var{language}.
5676
5677@item info extensions
5678List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
5679@end table
5680
6d2ebf8b 5681@node Checks
c906108c
SS
5682@section Type and range checking
5683
5684@quotation
5685@emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
5686checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
5687section documents the intended facilities.
5688@end quotation
5689@c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
5690
5691Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
5692errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
5693checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
5694sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
5695these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
5696by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
5697errors when your program is running.
5698
5699@value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
5700Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program, it
5701can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via
5702the @code{print} command, for example. As with the working language,
5703@value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check automatically based on
5704your program's source language. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages},
5705for the default settings of supported languages.
5706
5707@menu
5708* Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
5709* Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
5710@end menu
5711
5712@cindex type checking
5713@cindex checks, type
6d2ebf8b 5714@node Type Checking
c906108c
SS
5715@subsection An overview of type checking
5716
5717Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
5718arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
5719otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
5720errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
5721
5722@smallexample
57231 + 2 @result{} 3
5724@exdent but
5725@error{} 1 + 2.3
5726@end smallexample
5727
5728The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
5729type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
5730
5d161b24
DB
5731For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
5732@value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
5733to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
5734or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
c906108c
SS
5735but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
5736these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
5737also issues a warning.
5738
5d161b24
DB
5739Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
5740related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
5741For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
5742a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
5743with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
c906108c
SS
5744the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
5745
5746Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
5747instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
5748operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
5749represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
5750operators. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for further
5751details on specific languages.
5752
5753@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
5754
d4f3574e 5755@kindex set check@r{, type}
c906108c
SS
5756@kindex set check type
5757@kindex show check type
5758@table @code
5759@item set check type auto
5760Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
5761@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
5762each language.
5763
5764@item set check type on
5765@itemx set check type off
5766Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
5767current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
5768match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
d4f3574e 5769evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
c906108c
SS
5770message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
5771
5772@item set check type warn
5773Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
5774evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
5775be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
5776numbers and structures.
5777
5778@item show type
5d161b24 5779Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
5780is setting it automatically.
5781@end table
5782
5783@cindex range checking
5784@cindex checks, range
6d2ebf8b 5785@node Range Checking
c906108c
SS
5786@subsection An overview of range checking
5787
5788In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
5789bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
5790checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
5791computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
5792not exceed the bounds of the array.
5793
5794For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
5795@value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
5796always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
5797warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
5798
5799A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
5800array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
5801of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
5802error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
5803result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
5804the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
5805
5806@example
5807@var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
5808@end example
5809
5810This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
5811specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Support, ,
5812Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
5813
5814@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
5815
d4f3574e 5816@kindex set check@r{, range}
c906108c
SS
5817@kindex set check range
5818@kindex show check range
5819@table @code
5820@item set check range auto
5821Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
5822@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
5823each language.
5824
5825@item set check range on
5826@itemx set check range off
5827Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
5828current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
c3f6f71d
JM
5829match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
5830then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
c906108c
SS
5831
5832@item set check range warn
5833Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
5834but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
5835expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
5836memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
5837systems).
5838
5839@item show range
5840Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
5841being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
5842@end table
c906108c 5843
6d2ebf8b 5844@node Support
c906108c 5845@section Supported languages
c906108c 5846
cce74817
JM
5847@value{GDBN} supports C, C++, Fortran, Java, Chill, assembly, and Modula-2.
5848@c This is false ...
c906108c
SS
5849Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
5850language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
5851and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
5852,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
5853language.
5854
5855The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
5856supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
5857tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
5858@value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
5859formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
5860books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
5861language reference or tutorial.
5862
c906108c 5863@menu
7a292a7a 5864* C:: C and C++
cce74817 5865* Modula-2:: Modula-2
104c1213 5866* Chill:: Chill
c906108c
SS
5867@end menu
5868
6d2ebf8b 5869@node C
c906108c 5870@subsection C and C++
7a292a7a 5871
c906108c
SS
5872@cindex C and C++
5873@cindex expressions in C or C++
c906108c
SS
5874
5875Since C and C++ are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
5876to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
5877together.
5878
41afff9a
EZ
5879@cindex C@t{++}
5880@cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
c906108c
SS
5881@cindex @sc{gnu} C++
5882The C++ debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C++
5883compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C++ code
5884effectively, you must compile your C++ programs with a supported
5885C++ compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C++
5886compiler (@code{aCC}).
5887
5888For best results when using @sc{gnu} C++, use the stabs debugging
5889format. You can select that format explicitly with the @code{g++}
5890command-line options @samp{-gstabs} or @samp{-gstabs+}. See
5891@ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
5892CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more information.
c906108c 5893
c906108c
SS
5894@menu
5895* C Operators:: C and C++ operators
5896* C Constants:: C and C++ constants
7a292a7a 5897* C plus plus expressions:: C++ expressions
c906108c 5898* C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C++
c906108c 5899* C Checks:: C and C++ type and range checks
c906108c
SS
5900* Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
5901* Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C++
5902@end menu
c906108c 5903
6d2ebf8b 5904@node C Operators
c906108c 5905@subsubsection C and C++ operators
7a292a7a
SS
5906
5907@cindex C and C++ operators
c906108c
SS
5908
5909Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
5910@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
5d161b24 5911often defined on groups of types.
c906108c 5912
c906108c 5913For the purposes of C and C++, the following definitions hold:
c906108c
SS
5914
5915@itemize @bullet
53a5351d 5916
c906108c 5917@item
c906108c
SS
5918@emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
5919specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C++, @code{bool}.
c906108c
SS
5920
5921@item
d4f3574e
SS
5922@emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
5923@code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
c906108c
SS
5924
5925@item
53a5351d 5926@emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
c906108c
SS
5927
5928@item
5929@emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
53a5351d 5930
c906108c
SS
5931@end itemize
5932
5933@noindent
5934The following operators are supported. They are listed here
5935in order of increasing precedence:
5936
5937@table @code
5938@item ,
5939The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
5940are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
5941expression being the last expression evaluated.
5942
5943@item =
5944Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
5945assigned. Defined on scalar types.
5946
5947@item @var{op}=
5948Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
5949and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
d4f3574e 5950@w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
c906108c
SS
5951@var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
5952@code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
5953
5954@item ?:
5955The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
5956of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
5957integral type.
5958
5959@item ||
5960Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
5961
5962@item &&
5963Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
5964
5965@item |
5966Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
5967
5968@item ^
5969Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
5970
5971@item &
5972Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
5973
5974@item ==@r{, }!=
5975Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
5976expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
5977
5978@item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
5979Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
5980Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
5981and non-zero for true.
5982
5983@item <<@r{, }>>
5984left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
5985
5986@item @@
5987The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
5988
5989@item +@r{, }-
5990Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
5991pointer types.
5992
5993@item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
5994Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
5995defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
5996integral types.
5997
5998@item ++@r{, }--
5999Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
6000operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
6001when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
6002operation takes place.
6003
6004@item *
6005Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
6006@code{++}.
6007
6008@item &
6009Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
6010
c906108c
SS
6011For debugging C++, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
6012allowed in the C++ language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
6013(or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
6014where a C++ reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
6015stored.
c906108c
SS
6016
6017@item -
6018Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
6019precedence as @code{++}.
6020
6021@item !
6022Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
6023@code{++}.
6024
6025@item ~
6026Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
6027@code{++}.
6028
6029
6030@item .@r{, }->
6031Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
6032@value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
6033pointer based on the stored type information.
6034Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
6035
c906108c
SS
6036@item .*@r{, }->*
6037Dereferences of pointers to members.
c906108c
SS
6038
6039@item []
6040Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
6041@code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
6042
6043@item ()
6044Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
6045
c906108c 6046@item ::
7a292a7a
SS
6047C++ scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
6048and @code{class} types.
c906108c
SS
6049
6050@item ::
7a292a7a
SS
6051Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
6052(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
6053above.
c906108c
SS
6054@end table
6055
c906108c
SS
6056If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
6057attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
6058predefined meaning.
c906108c 6059
c906108c 6060@menu
5d161b24 6061* C Constants::
c906108c
SS
6062@end menu
6063
6d2ebf8b 6064@node C Constants
c906108c 6065@subsubsection C and C++ constants
c906108c
SS
6066
6067@cindex C and C++ constants
c906108c 6068
7a292a7a 6069@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C++ in the
c906108c 6070following ways:
c906108c
SS
6071
6072@itemize @bullet
6073@item
6074Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
6075specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e. zero), and hexadecimal constants by
6076a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
6077@samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
6078@code{long} value.
6079
6080@item
6081Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
6082point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
6083exponent. An exponent is of the form:
6084@samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
6085sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
d4f3574e
SS
6086A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
6087@samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
6088the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
6089a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
6090constant.
c906108c
SS
6091
6092@item
6093Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
6094integral equivalents.
6095
6096@item
6097Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
6098(@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
d4f3574e 6099(usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
c906108c
SS
6100be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
6101the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
6102of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
6103@samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
6104@samp{\n} for newline.
6105
6106@item
96a2c332
SS
6107String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
6108double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
6109above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
6110a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
6111characters.
c906108c
SS
6112
6113@item
6114Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
6115to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
6116
6117@item
6118Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
6119and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
6120integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
6121and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
6122@end itemize
6123
c906108c 6124@menu
5d161b24
DB
6125* C plus plus expressions::
6126* C Defaults::
6127* C Checks::
c906108c 6128
5d161b24 6129* Debugging C::
c906108c
SS
6130@end menu
6131
6d2ebf8b 6132@node C plus plus expressions
c906108c 6133@subsubsection C++ expressions
c906108c
SS
6134
6135@cindex expressions in C++
6136@value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C++ expressions.
6137
c906108c
SS
6138@cindex C++ support, not in @sc{coff}
6139@cindex @sc{coff} versus C++
6140@cindex C++ and object formats
6141@cindex object formats and C++
6142@cindex a.out and C++
6143@cindex @sc{ecoff} and C++
6144@cindex @sc{xcoff} and C++
6145@cindex @sc{elf}/stabs and C++
6146@cindex @sc{elf}/@sc{dwarf} and C++
6147@c FIXME!! GDB may eventually be able to debug C++ using DWARF; check
6148@c periodically whether this has happened...
6149@quotation
6150@emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C++ code if you use the
6151proper compiler. Typically, C++ debugging depends on the use of
6152additional debugging information in the symbol table, and thus requires
6153special support. In particular, if your compiler generates a.out, MIPS
6154@sc{ecoff}, RS/6000 @sc{xcoff}, or @sc{elf} with stabs extensions to the
6155symbol table, these facilities are all available. (With @sc{gnu} CC,
6156you can use the @samp{-gstabs} option to request stabs debugging
6157extensions explicitly.) Where the object code format is standard
6158@sc{coff} or @sc{dwarf} in @sc{elf}, on the other hand, most of the C++
6159support in @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} work.
6160@end quotation
c906108c
SS
6161
6162@enumerate
6163
6164@cindex member functions
6165@item
6166Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
6167
6168@example
6169count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
6170@end example
6171
41afff9a 6172@vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
c906108c
SS
6173@cindex namespace in C++
6174@item
6175While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
6176expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
6177that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
6178pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C++.
6179
c906108c 6180@cindex call overloaded functions
d4f3574e 6181@cindex overloaded functions, calling
c906108c
SS
6182@cindex type conversions in C++
6183@item
6184You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
d4f3574e 6185call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
c906108c
SS
6186perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
6187calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
6188in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
6189default arguments.
6190
6191It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
6192promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
6193class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
6194functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
6195number of function arguments.
6196
6197Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
6198@code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
6199,@value{GDBN} features for C++}.
6200
d4f3574e 6201You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
c906108c
SS
6202explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
6203@smallexample
6204p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
6205@end smallexample
d4f3574e 6206
c906108c 6207The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
d4f3574e 6208see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
c906108c 6209
c906108c
SS
6210@cindex reference declarations
6211@item
5d161b24 6212@value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C++ references; you can use
c906108c
SS
6213them in expressions just as you do in C++ source---they are automatically
6214dereferenced.
6215
6216In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
6217reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
6218avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
6219The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
6220you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
6221
6222@item
6223@value{GDBN} supports the C++ name resolution operator @code{::}---your
6224expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
6225one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
6226necessary, for example in an expression like
6227@samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
6228resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C++
6229debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
6230@end enumerate
6231
53a5351d
JM
6232In addition, when used with HP's C++ compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
6233calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
6234objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
6235invoking user-defined operators.
c906108c 6236
6d2ebf8b 6237@node C Defaults
c906108c 6238@subsubsection C and C++ defaults
7a292a7a 6239
c906108c
SS
6240@cindex C and C++ defaults
6241
c906108c
SS
6242If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
6243both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
6244C or C++. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
6245selects the working language.
c906108c
SS
6246
6247If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
6248recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
6249@file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
6250these files, it sets the working language to C or C++.
6251@xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
6252for further details.
6253
c906108c
SS
6254@c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
6255@c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
6256@c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
7a292a7a 6257
6d2ebf8b 6258@node C Checks
c906108c 6259@subsubsection C and C++ type and range checks
7a292a7a 6260
c906108c
SS
6261@cindex C and C++ checks
6262
6263By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C++ expressions, type checking
6264is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
6265considers two variables type equivalent if:
6266
6267@itemize @bullet
6268@item
6269The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
6270enumerated tag.
6271
6272@item
6273The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
6274declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
6275
6276@ignore
6277@c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
6278@c FIXME--beers?
6279@item
6280The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
6281declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
6282compilers.)
6283@end ignore
6284@end itemize
6285
6286Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
6287indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
6288that is not itself an array.
c906108c 6289
6d2ebf8b 6290@node Debugging C
c906108c 6291@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
c906108c
SS
6292
6293The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
6294the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
7a292a7a
SS
6295inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
6296appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
c906108c
SS
6297
6298The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
6299with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
6300,Expressions}.
6301
c906108c 6302@menu
5d161b24 6303* Debugging C plus plus::
c906108c
SS
6304@end menu
6305
6d2ebf8b 6306@node Debugging C plus plus
c906108c 6307@subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C++
c906108c
SS
6308
6309@cindex commands for C++
7a292a7a 6310
c906108c
SS
6311Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C++, and some are
6312designed specifically for use with C++. Here is a summary:
6313
6314@table @code
6315@cindex break in overloaded functions
6316@item @r{breakpoint menus}
6317When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
6318@value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
6319you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
6320
6321@cindex overloading in C++
6322@item rbreak @var{regex}
6323Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
6324breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
6325classes.
6326@xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
6327
6328@cindex C++ exception handling
6329@item catch throw
6330@itemx catch catch
6331Debug C++ exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
6332Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
6333
6334@cindex inheritance
6335@item ptype @var{typename}
6336Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
6337@var{typename}.
6338@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
6339
6340@cindex C++ symbol display
6341@item set print demangle
6342@itemx show print demangle
6343@itemx set print asm-demangle
6344@itemx show print asm-demangle
6345Control whether C++ symbols display in their source form, both when
6346displaying code as C++ source and when displaying disassemblies.
6347@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
6348
6349@item set print object
6350@itemx show print object
6351Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
6352@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
6353
6354@item set print vtbl
6355@itemx show print vtbl
6356Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
6357@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
c906108c
SS
6358(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
6359ANSI C++ compiler (@code{aCC}).)
6360
6361@kindex set overload-resolution
d4f3574e 6362@cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
c906108c
SS
6363@item set overload-resolution on
6364Enable overload resolution for C++ expression evaluation. The default
6365is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
6366and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
d4f3574e
SS
6367using the standard C++ conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C++
6368expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
c906108c
SS
6369message.
6370
6371@item set overload-resolution off
6372Disable overload resolution for C++ expression evaluation. For
6373overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
6374chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
6375symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
6376overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
6377searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
6378argument types.
c906108c
SS
6379
6380@item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
6381You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
6382the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C++: type
6383@code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
6384also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
6385available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
6386@xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
6387@end table
c906108c 6388
6d2ebf8b 6389@node Modula-2
c906108c 6390@subsection Modula-2
7a292a7a 6391
d4f3574e 6392@cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
c906108c
SS
6393
6394The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
6395output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
6396developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
6397attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
6398to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
6399table.
6400
6401@cindex expressions in Modula-2
6402@menu
6403* M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
6404* Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
6405* M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
6406* M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
6407* Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
6408* M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
6409* M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
6410* GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
6411@end menu
6412
6d2ebf8b 6413@node M2 Operators
c906108c
SS
6414@subsubsection Operators
6415@cindex Modula-2 operators
6416
6417Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
6418@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
6419often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
6420following definitions hold:
6421
6422@itemize @bullet
6423
6424@item
6425@emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
6426their subranges.
6427
6428@item
6429@emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
6430
6431@item
6432@emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
6433
6434@item
6435@emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
6436@var{type}}.
6437
6438@item
6439@emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
6440
6441@item
6442@emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
6443
6444@item
6445@emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
6446@end itemize
6447
6448@noindent
6449The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
6450increasing precedence:
6451
6452@table @code
6453@item ,
6454Function argument or array index separator.
6455
6456@item :=
6457Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
6458@var{value}.
6459
6460@item <@r{, }>
6461Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
6462types.
6463
6464@item <=@r{, }>=
96a2c332 6465Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
c906108c
SS
6466on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
6467set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
6468
6469@item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
6470Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
6471Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
6472available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
6473comment character.
6474
6475@item IN
6476Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
6477Same precedence as @code{<}.
6478
6479@item OR
6480Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
6481
6482@item AND@r{, }&
d4f3574e 6483Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
c906108c
SS
6484
6485@item @@
6486The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
6487
6488@item +@r{, }-
6489Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
6490and difference on set types.
6491
6492@item *
6493Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
6494on set types.
6495
6496@item /
6497Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
6498types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
6499
6500@item DIV@r{, }MOD
6501Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
6502precedence as @code{*}.
6503
6504@item -
6505Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
6506
6507@item ^
6508Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
6509
6510@item NOT
6511Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
6512@code{^}.
6513
6514@item .
6515@code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
6516precedence as @code{^}.
6517
6518@item []
6519Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
6520
6521@item ()
6522Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
6523as @code{^}.
6524
6525@item ::@r{, }.
6526@value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
6527@end table
6528
6529@quotation
6530@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
6531treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
6532@code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
6533@code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
6534@end quotation
6535
6536@cindex Modula-2 built-ins
6d2ebf8b 6537@node Built-In Func/Proc
c906108c
SS
6538@subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
6539
6540Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
6541In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
6542
6543@table @var
6544
6545@item a
6546represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
6547
6548@item c
6549represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
6550
6551@item i
6552represents a variable or constant of integral type.
6553
6554@item m
6555represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
6556same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
6557be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
6558
6559@item n
6560represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
6561
6562@item r
6563represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
6564
6565@item t
6566represents a type.
6567
6568@item v
6569represents a variable.
6570
6571@item x
6572represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
6573explanation of the function for details.
6574@end table
6575
6576All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
6577
6578@table @code
6579@item ABS(@var{n})
6580Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
6581
6582@item CAP(@var{c})
6583If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
c3f6f71d 6584equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
c906108c
SS
6585
6586@item CHR(@var{i})
6587Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
6588
6589@item DEC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 6590Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
6591
6592@item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
6593Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
6594new value.
6595
6596@item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
6597Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
6598set.
6599
6600@item FLOAT(@var{i})
6601Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
6602
6603@item HIGH(@var{a})
6604Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
6605
6606@item INC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 6607Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
6608
6609@item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
6610Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
6611new value.
6612
6613@item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
6614Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
6615there. Returns the new set.
6616
6617@item MAX(@var{t})
6618Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
6619
6620@item MIN(@var{t})
6621Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
6622
6623@item ODD(@var{i})
6624Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
6625
6626@item ORD(@var{x})
6627Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
c3f6f71d
JM
6628value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
6629@sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
c906108c
SS
6630integral, character and enumerated types.
6631
6632@item SIZE(@var{x})
6633Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
6634
6635@item TRUNC(@var{r})
6636Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
6637
6638@item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
6639Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
6640@end table
6641
6642@quotation
6643@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
6644@value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
6645an error.
6646@end quotation
6647
6648@cindex Modula-2 constants
6d2ebf8b 6649@node M2 Constants
c906108c
SS
6650@subsubsection Constants
6651
6652@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
6653ways:
6654
6655@itemize @bullet
6656
6657@item
6658Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
6659expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
6660rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
6661trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
6662
6663@item
6664Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
6665decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
6666then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
6667@samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
6668digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
6669digits.
6670
6671@item
6672Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
6673like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
c3f6f71d 6674also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
c906108c
SS
6675followed by a @samp{C}.
6676
6677@item
6678String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
6679pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
6680Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
6681Constants, ,C and C++ constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
6682sequences.
6683
6684@item
6685Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
6686
6687@item
6688Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
6689@code{FALSE}.
6690
6691@item
6692Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
6693
6694@item
6695Set constants are not yet supported.
6696@end itemize
6697
6d2ebf8b 6698@node M2 Defaults
c906108c
SS
6699@subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
6700@cindex Modula-2 defaults
6701
6702If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
6703both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
d4f3574e 6704Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
6705selected the working language.
6706
6707If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
6708code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
d4f3574e 6709working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
c906108c
SS
6710the language automatically}, for further details.
6711
6d2ebf8b 6712@node Deviations
c906108c
SS
6713@subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
6714@cindex Modula-2, deviations from
6715
6716A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
6717This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
6718
6719@itemize @bullet
6720@item
6721Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
6722integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
6723debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
6724pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
6725through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
6726returned a pointer.)
6727
6728@item
6729C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
6730non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
6731escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
6732printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
6733
6734@item
6735The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
6736argument.
6737
6738@item
6739All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
6740@end itemize
6741
6d2ebf8b 6742@node M2 Checks
c906108c
SS
6743@subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
6744@cindex Modula-2 checks
6745
6746@quotation
6747@emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
6748range checking.
6749@end quotation
6750@c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
6751
6752@value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
6753
6754@itemize @bullet
6755@item
6756They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
6757@var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
6758
6759@item
6760They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
6761@sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
6762@end itemize
6763
6764As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
6765whose types are not equivalent is an error.
6766
6767Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
6768index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
6769
6d2ebf8b 6770@node M2 Scope
c906108c
SS
6771@subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
6772@cindex scope
41afff9a 6773@cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
c906108c
SS
6774@cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
6775@ifinfo
41afff9a 6776@vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
6777@c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
6778@end ifinfo
6779@iftex
41afff9a 6780@vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
6781@end iftex
6782
6783There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
6784(@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
6785similar syntax:
6786
6787@example
6788
6789@var{module} . @var{id}
6790@var{scope} :: @var{id}
6791@end example
6792
6793@noindent
6794where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
6795@var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
6796identifier within your program, except another module.
6797
6798Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
6799specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
6800found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
6801enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
6802
6803Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
6804the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
6805definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
6806an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
6807module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
6808@var{module}.
6809
6d2ebf8b 6810@node GDB/M2
c906108c
SS
6811@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
6812
6813Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
6814Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
6815specifically to C and C++: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
6816@samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
6817apply to C++, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
6818analogue in Modula-2.
6819
6820The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
d4f3574e 6821with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
c906108c
SS
6822intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
6823created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C++. However, because an
6824address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
d4f3574e 6825@samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
c906108c
SS
6826
6827@cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
6828In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
6829interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
c906108c 6830
6d2ebf8b 6831@node Chill
cce74817
JM
6832@subsection Chill
6833
6834The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Chill only support output
d4f3574e 6835from the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler. Other Chill compilers are not currently
cce74817
JM
6836supported, and attempting to debug executables produced by them is most
6837likely to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
6838table.
6839
d4f3574e
SS
6840@c This used to say "... following Chill related topics ...", but since
6841@c menus are not shown in the printed manual, it would look awkward.
6842This section covers the Chill related topics and the features
cce74817
JM
6843of @value{GDBN} which support these topics.
6844
6845@menu
104c1213
JM
6846* How modes are displayed:: How modes are displayed
6847* Locations:: Locations and their accesses
cce74817 6848* Values and their Operations:: Values and their Operations
5d161b24 6849* Chill type and range checks::
53a5351d 6850* Chill defaults::
cce74817
JM
6851@end menu
6852
6d2ebf8b 6853@node How modes are displayed
cce74817
JM
6854@subsubsection How modes are displayed
6855
6856The Chill Datatype- (Mode) support of @value{GDBN} is directly related
d4f3574e 6857with the functionality of the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler, and therefore deviates
cce74817
JM
6858slightly from the standard specification of the Chill language. The
6859provided modes are:
d4f3574e
SS
6860
6861@c FIXME: this @table's contents effectively disable @code by using @r
6862@c on every @item. So why does it need @code?
cce74817
JM
6863@table @code
6864@item @r{@emph{Discrete modes:}}
6865@itemize @bullet
6866@item
6867@emph{Integer Modes} which are predefined by @code{BYTE, UBYTE, INT,
6868UINT, LONG, ULONG},
6869@item
5d161b24 6870@emph{Boolean Mode} which is predefined by @code{BOOL},
cce74817 6871@item
5d161b24 6872@emph{Character Mode} which is predefined by @code{CHAR},
cce74817
JM
6873@item
6874@emph{Set Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{SET}.
6875@smallexample
6876(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
6877type = SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
6878@end smallexample
6879If the type is an unnumbered set the set element values are omitted.
6880@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
6881@emph{Range Mode} which is displayed by
6882@smallexample
6883@code{type = <basemode>(<lower bound> : <upper bound>)}
6884@end smallexample
6885where @code{<lower bound>, <upper bound>} can be of any discrete literal
6886expression (e.g. set element names).
cce74817
JM
6887@end itemize
6888
6889@item @r{@emph{Powerset Mode:}}
6890A Powerset Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{POWERSET} followed by
d4f3574e 6891the member mode of the powerset. The member mode can be any discrete mode.
cce74817
JM
6892@smallexample
6893(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
6894type = POWERSET SET (egon, hugo, otto)
6895@end smallexample
6896
6897@item @r{@emph{Reference Modes:}}
6898@itemize @bullet
6899@item
d4f3574e 6900@emph{Bound Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{REF}
cce74817
JM
6901followed by the mode name to which the reference is bound.
6902@item
6903@emph{Free Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{PTR}.
6904@end itemize
6905
6906@item @r{@emph{Procedure mode}}
6907The procedure mode is displayed by @code{type = PROC(<parameter list>)
6908<return mode> EXCEPTIONS (<exception list>)}. The @code{<parameter
d4f3574e
SS
6909list>} is a list of the parameter modes. @code{<return mode>} indicates
6910the mode of the result of the procedure if any. The exceptionlist lists
cce74817
JM
6911all possible exceptions which can be raised by the procedure.
6912
6913@ignore
6914@item @r{@emph{Instance mode}}
6915The instance mode is represented by a structure, which has a static
5d161b24 6916type, and is therefore not really of interest.
cce74817
JM
6917@end ignore
6918
5d161b24 6919@item @r{@emph{Synchronization Modes:}}
cce74817
JM
6920@itemize @bullet
6921@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
6922@emph{Event Mode} which is displayed by
6923@smallexample
6924@code{EVENT (<event length>)}
6925@end smallexample
cce74817
JM
6926where @code{(<event length>)} is optional.
6927@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
6928@emph{Buffer Mode} which is displayed by
6929@smallexample
6930@code{BUFFER (<buffer length>)<buffer element mode>}
6931@end smallexample
6932where @code{(<buffer length>)} is optional.
cce74817
JM
6933@end itemize
6934
5d161b24 6935@item @r{@emph{Timing Modes:}}
cce74817
JM
6936@itemize @bullet
6937@item
6938@emph{Duration Mode} which is predefined by @code{DURATION}
6939@item
6940@emph{Absolute Time Mode} which is predefined by @code{TIME}
6941@end itemize
6942
6943@item @r{@emph{Real Modes:}}
6944Real Modes are predefined with @code{REAL} and @code{LONG_REAL}.
6945
6946@item @r{@emph{String Modes:}}
6947@itemize @bullet
6948@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
6949@emph{Character String Mode} which is displayed by
6950@smallexample
6951@code{CHARS(<string length>)}
6952@end smallexample
6953followed by the keyword @code{VARYING} if the String Mode is a varying
6954mode
cce74817 6955@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
6956@emph{Bit String Mode} which is displayed by
6957@smallexample
6958@code{BOOLS(<string
6959length>)}
6960@end smallexample
cce74817
JM
6961@end itemize
6962
6963@item @r{@emph{Array Mode:}}
6964The Array Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{ARRAY(<range>)}
6965followed by the element mode (which may in turn be an array mode).
6966@smallexample
6967(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
5d161b24
DB
6968type = ARRAY (1:42)
6969 ARRAY (1:20)
cce74817
JM
6970 SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
6971@end smallexample
6972
5d161b24 6973@item @r{@emph{Structure Mode}}
cce74817 6974The Structure mode is displayed by the keyword @code{STRUCT(<field
d4f3574e
SS
6975list>)}. The @code{<field list>} consists of names and modes of fields
6976of the structure. Variant structures have the keyword @code{CASE <field>
6977OF <variant fields> ESAC} in their field list. Since the current version
cce74817
JM
6978of the GNU Chill compiler doesn't implement tag processing (no runtime
6979checks of variant fields, and therefore no debugging info), the output
6980always displays all variant fields.
6981@smallexample
6982(@value{GDBP}) ptype str
6983type = STRUCT (
6984 as x,
6985 bs x,
6986 CASE bs OF
6987 (karli):
6988 cs a
6989 (ott):
6990 ds x
6991 ESAC
6992)
6993@end smallexample
6994@end table
6995
6d2ebf8b 6996@node Locations
cce74817
JM
6997@subsubsection Locations and their accesses
6998
6999A location in Chill is an object which can contain values.
7000
7001A value of a location is generally accessed by the (declared) name of
d4f3574e
SS
7002the location. The output conforms to the specification of values in
7003Chill programs. How values are specified
7004is the topic of the next section, @ref{Values and their Operations}.
cce74817
JM
7005
7006The pseudo-location @code{RESULT} (or @code{result}) can be used to
7007display or change the result of a currently-active procedure:
d4f3574e 7008
cce74817
JM
7009@smallexample
7010set result := EXPR
7011@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
7012
7013@noindent
7014This does the same as the Chill action @code{RESULT EXPR} (which
c3f6f71d 7015is not available in @value{GDBN}).
cce74817
JM
7016
7017Values of reference mode locations are printed by @code{PTR(<hex
7018value>)} in case of a free reference mode, and by @code{(REF <reference
d4f3574e 7019mode>) (<hex-value>)} in case of a bound reference. @code{<hex value>}
cce74817
JM
7020represents the address where the reference points to. To access the
7021value of the location referenced by the pointer, use the dereference
d4f3574e 7022operator @samp{->}.
cce74817 7023
6d2ebf8b
SS
7024Values of procedure mode locations are displayed by
7025@smallexample
7026@code{@{ PROC
cce74817 7027(<argument modes> ) <return mode> @} <address> <name of procedure
6d2ebf8b
SS
7028location>}
7029@end smallexample
7030@code{<argument modes>} is a list of modes according to the parameter
7031specification of the procedure and @code{<address>} shows the address of
7032the entry point.
cce74817
JM
7033
7034@ignore
7035Locations of instance modes are displayed just like a structure with two
7036fields specifying the @emph{process type} and the @emph{copy number} of
7037the investigated instance location@footnote{This comes from the current
d4f3574e
SS
7038implementation of instances. They are implemented as a structure (no
7039na). The output should be something like @code{[<name of the process>;
7040<instance number>]}.}. The field names are @code{__proc_type} and
cce74817
JM
7041@code{__proc_copy}.
7042
7043Locations of synchronization modes are displayed like a structure with
7044the field name @code{__event_data} in case of a event mode location, and
7045like a structure with the field @code{__buffer_data} in case of a buffer
7046mode location (refer to previous paragraph).
7047
7048Structure Mode locations are printed by @code{[.<field name>: <value>,
d4f3574e 7049...]}. The @code{<field name>} corresponds to the structure mode
cce74817 7050definition and the layout of @code{<value>} varies depending of the mode
d4f3574e
SS
7051of the field. If the investigated structure mode location is of variant
7052structure mode, the variant parts of the structure are enclosed in curled
7053braces (@samp{@{@}}). Fields enclosed by @samp{@{,@}} are residing
cce74817 7054on the same memory location and represent the current values of the
d4f3574e 7055memory location in their specific modes. Since no tag processing is done
cce74817 7056all variants are displayed. A variant field is printed by
d4f3574e 7057@code{(<variant name>) = .<field name>: <value>}. (who implements the
cce74817
JM
7058stuff ???)
7059@smallexample
7060(@value{GDBP}) print str1 $4 = [.as: 0, .bs: karli, .<TAG>: { (karli) =
7061[.cs: []], (susi) = [.ds: susi]}]
7062@end smallexample
7063@end ignore
7064
7065Substructures of string mode-, array mode- or structure mode-values
7066(e.g. array slices, fields of structure locations) are accessed using
d4f3574e
SS
7067certain operations which are described in the next section, @ref{Values
7068and their Operations}.
cce74817
JM
7069
7070A location value may be interpreted as having a different mode using the
d4f3574e
SS
7071location conversion. This mode conversion is written as @code{<mode
7072name>(<location>)}. The user has to consider that the sizes of the modes
7073have to be equal otherwise an error occurs. Furthermore, no range
7074checking of the location against the destination mode is performed, and
cce74817 7075therefore the result can be quite confusing.
d4f3574e 7076
cce74817
JM
7077@smallexample
7078(@value{GDBP}) print int (s(3 up 4)) XXX TO be filled in !! XXX
7079@end smallexample
7080
6d2ebf8b 7081@node Values and their Operations
cce74817
JM
7082@subsubsection Values and their Operations
7083
7084Values are used to alter locations, to investigate complex structures in
7085more detail or to filter relevant information out of a large amount of
d4f3574e
SS
7086data. There are several (mode dependent) operations defined which enable
7087such investigations. These operations are not only applicable to
cce74817 7088constant values but also to locations, which can become quite useful
d4f3574e 7089when debugging complex structures. During parsing the command line
cce74817
JM
7090(e.g. evaluating an expression) @value{GDBN} treats location names as
7091the values behind these locations.
7092
d4f3574e 7093This section describes how values have to be specified and which
cce74817
JM
7094operations are legal to be used with such values.
7095
7096@table @code
7097@item Literal Values
d4f3574e
SS
7098Literal values are specified in the same manner as in @sc{gnu} Chill programs.
7099For detailed specification refer to the @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual
cce74817 7100chapter 1.5.
d4f3574e
SS
7101@c FIXME: if the Chill Manual is a Texinfo documents, the above should
7102@c be converted to a @ref.
cce74817 7103
5d161b24 7104@ignore
cce74817
JM
7105@itemize @bullet
7106@item
7107@emph{Integer Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
d4f3574e 7108programs (refer to the Chill Standard z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.2)
cce74817
JM
7109@item
7110@emph{Boolean Literals} are defined by @code{TRUE} and @code{FALSE}.
7111@item
7112@emph{Character Literals} are defined by @code{'<character>'}. (e.g.
7113@code{'M'})
7114@item
7115@emph{Set Literals} are defined by a name which was specified in a set
d4f3574e
SS
7116mode. The value delivered by a Set Literal is the set value. This is
7117comparable to an enumeration in C/C++ language.
cce74817 7118@item
d4f3574e 7119@emph{Emptiness Literal} is predefined by @code{NULL}. The value of the
cce74817 7120emptiness literal delivers either the empty reference value, the empty
5d161b24 7121procedure value or the empty instance value.
cce74817
JM
7122
7123@item
7124@emph{Character String Literals} are defined by a sequence of characters
d4f3574e 7125enclosed in single- or double quotes. If a single- or double quote has
cce74817
JM
7126to be part of the string literal it has to be stuffed (specified twice).
7127@item
7128@emph{Bitstring Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
7129programs (refer z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.8).
7130@item
7131@emph{Floating point literals} are specified in the same manner as in
d4f3574e 7132(gnu-)Chill programs (refer @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual chapter 1.5).
cce74817
JM
7133@end itemize
7134@end ignore
7135
7136@item Tuple Values
7137A tuple is specified by @code{<mode name>[<tuple>]}, where @code{<mode
d4f3574e 7138name>} can be omitted if the mode of the tuple is unambiguous. This
cce74817
JM
7139unambiguity is derived from the context of a evaluated expression.
7140@code{<tuple>} can be one of the following:
d4f3574e 7141
cce74817
JM
7142@itemize @bullet
7143@item @emph{Powerset Tuple}
7144@item @emph{Array Tuple}
7145@item @emph{Structure Tuple}
7146Powerset tuples, array tuples and structure tuples are specified in the
d4f3574e 7147same manner as in Chill programs refer to z200/88 chpt 5.2.5.
cce74817
JM
7148@end itemize
7149
7150@item String Element Value
6d2ebf8b
SS
7151A string element value is specified by
7152@smallexample
7153@code{<string value>(<index>)}
7154@end smallexample
d4f3574e 7155where @code{<index>} is a integer expression. It delivers a character
cce74817
JM
7156value which is equivalent to the character indexed by @code{<index>} in
7157the string.
7158
7159@item String Slice Value
7160A string slice value is specified by @code{<string value>(<slice
7161spec>)}, where @code{<slice spec>} can be either a range of integer
7162expressions or specified by @code{<start expr> up <size>}.
7163@code{<size>} denotes the number of elements which the slice contains.
7164The delivered value is a string value, which is part of the specified
7165string.
7166
7167@item Array Element Values
7168An array element value is specified by @code{<array value>(<expr>)} and
7169delivers a array element value of the mode of the specified array.
7170
7171@item Array Slice Values
7172An array slice is specified by @code{<array value>(<slice spec>)}, where
7173@code{<slice spec>} can be either a range specified by expressions or by
d4f3574e
SS
7174@code{<start expr> up <size>}. @code{<size>} denotes the number of
7175arrayelements the slice contains. The delivered value is an array value
cce74817
JM
7176which is part of the specified array.
7177
7178@item Structure Field Values
7179A structure field value is derived by @code{<structure value>.<field
d4f3574e
SS
7180name>}, where @code{<field name>} indicates the name of a field specified
7181in the mode definition of the structure. The mode of the delivered value
cce74817
JM
7182corresponds to this mode definition in the structure definition.
7183
7184@item Procedure Call Value
7185The procedure call value is derived from the return value of the
7186procedure@footnote{If a procedure call is used for instance in an
7187expression, then this procedure is called with all its side
d4f3574e 7188effects. This can lead to confusing results if used carelessly.}.
cce74817 7189
d4f3574e 7190Values of duration mode locations are represented by @code{ULONG} literals.
cce74817 7191
6d2ebf8b
SS
7192Values of time mode locations appear as
7193@smallexample
7194@code{TIME(<secs>:<nsecs>)}
7195@end smallexample
7196
cce74817
JM
7197
7198@ignore
7199This is not implemented yet:
7200@item Built-in Value
7201@noindent
7202The following built in functions are provided:
d4f3574e 7203
cce74817
JM
7204@table @code
7205@item @code{ADDR()}
7206@item @code{NUM()}
7207@item @code{PRED()}
7208@item @code{SUCC()}
7209@item @code{ABS()}
7210@item @code{CARD()}
7211@item @code{MAX()}
7212@item @code{MIN()}
7213@item @code{SIZE()}
7214@item @code{UPPER()}
7215@item @code{LOWER()}
7216@item @code{LENGTH()}
7217@item @code{SIN()}
7218@item @code{COS()}
7219@item @code{TAN()}
7220@item @code{ARCSIN()}
7221@item @code{ARCCOS()}
7222@item @code{ARCTAN()}
7223@item @code{EXP()}
7224@item @code{LN()}
7225@item @code{LOG()}
7226@item @code{SQRT()}
7227@end table
7228
7229For a detailed description refer to the GNU Chill implementation manual
7230chapter 1.6.
7231@end ignore
7232
7233@item Zero-adic Operator Value
7234The zero-adic operator value is derived from the instance value for the
7235current active process.
7236
7237@item Expression Values
7238The value delivered by an expression is the result of the evaluation of
d4f3574e 7239the specified expression. If there are error conditions (mode
cce74817 7240incompatibility, etc.) the evaluation of expressions is aborted with a
d4f3574e 7241corresponding error message. Expressions may be parenthesised which
cce74817 7242causes the evaluation of this expression before any other expression
d4f3574e 7243which uses the result of the parenthesised expression. The following
cce74817 7244operators are supported by @value{GDBN}:
d4f3574e 7245
cce74817
JM
7246@table @code
7247@item @code{OR, ORIF, XOR}
d4f3574e
SS
7248@itemx @code{AND, ANDIF}
7249@itemx @code{NOT}
cce74817 7250Logical operators defined over operands of boolean mode.
d4f3574e 7251
cce74817
JM
7252@item @code{=, /=}
7253Equality and inequality operators defined over all modes.
d4f3574e 7254
cce74817 7255@item @code{>, >=}
d4f3574e 7256@itemx @code{<, <=}
cce74817 7257Relational operators defined over predefined modes.
d4f3574e 7258
cce74817 7259@item @code{+, -}
d4f3574e 7260@itemx @code{*, /, MOD, REM}
cce74817 7261Arithmetic operators defined over predefined modes.
d4f3574e 7262
cce74817
JM
7263@item @code{-}
7264Change sign operator.
d4f3574e 7265
cce74817
JM
7266@item @code{//}
7267String concatenation operator.
d4f3574e 7268
cce74817
JM
7269@item @code{()}
7270String repetition operator.
d4f3574e 7271
cce74817
JM
7272@item @code{->}
7273Referenced location operator which can be used either to take the
7274address of a location (@code{->loc}), or to dereference a reference
7275location (@code{loc->}).
d4f3574e 7276
cce74817 7277@item @code{OR, XOR}
d4f3574e
SS
7278@itemx @code{AND}
7279@itemx @code{NOT}
cce74817 7280Powerset and bitstring operators.
d4f3574e 7281
cce74817 7282@item @code{>, >=}
d4f3574e 7283@itemx @code{<, <=}
cce74817 7284Powerset inclusion operators.
d4f3574e 7285
cce74817
JM
7286@item @code{IN}
7287Membership operator.
7288@end table
7289@end table
7290
6d2ebf8b 7291@node Chill type and range checks
cce74817
JM
7292@subsubsection Chill type and range checks
7293
7294@value{GDBN} considers two Chill variables mode equivalent if the sizes
d4f3574e 7295of the two modes are equal. This rule applies recursively to more
cce74817 7296complex datatypes which means that complex modes are treated
d4f3574e 7297equivalent if all element modes (which also can be complex modes like
cce74817
JM
7298structures, arrays, etc.) have the same size.
7299
7300Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
7301index bounds and all built in procedures.
7302
7303Strong type checks are forced using the @value{GDBN} command @code{set
d4f3574e 7304check strong}. This enforces strong type and range checks on all
cce74817
JM
7305operations where Chill constructs are used (expressions, built in
7306functions, etc.) in respect to the semantics as defined in the z.200
7307language specification.
7308
cce74817
JM
7309All checks can be disabled by the @value{GDBN} command @code{set check
7310off}.
7311
5d161b24 7312@ignore
53a5351d 7313@c Deviations from the Chill Standard Z200/88
cce74817
JM
7314see last paragraph ?
7315@end ignore
7316
6d2ebf8b 7317@node Chill defaults
cce74817
JM
7318@subsubsection Chill defaults
7319
7320If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
7321both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
d4f3574e 7322Chill. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
cce74817
JM
7323selected the working language.
7324
7325If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
7326code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.ch} sets the
d4f3574e 7327working language to Chill. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
cce74817
JM
7328the language automatically}, for further details.
7329
6d2ebf8b 7330@node Symbols
c906108c
SS
7331@chapter Examining the Symbol Table
7332
d4f3574e 7333The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
c906108c
SS
7334symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
7335program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
7336does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
7337program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
7338(@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
7339file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
7340
7341@cindex symbol names
7342@cindex names of symbols
7343@cindex quoting names
7344Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
7345characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
7346most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
7347source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
7348are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
7349ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
7350@samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
7351@samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
7352
7353@example
7354p 'foo.c'::x
7355@end example
7356
7357@noindent
7358looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
7359
7360@table @code
7361@kindex info address
7362@item info address @var{symbol}
7363Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
7364variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
7365local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
7366is always stored.
7367
7368Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
7369at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
7370the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
7371
7372@kindex whatis
d4f3574e
SS
7373@item whatis @var{expr}
7374Print the data type of expression @var{expr}. @var{expr} is not
c906108c
SS
7375actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
7376assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
7377@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
7378
7379@item whatis
7380Print the data type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
7381
7382@kindex ptype
7383@item ptype @var{typename}
7384Print a description of data type @var{typename}. @var{typename} may be
7a292a7a
SS
7385the name of a type, or for C code it may have the form @samp{class
7386@var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
7387@var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
c906108c 7388
d4f3574e 7389@item ptype @var{expr}
c906108c 7390@itemx ptype
d4f3574e 7391Print a description of the type of expression @var{expr}. @code{ptype}
c906108c
SS
7392differs from @code{whatis} by printing a detailed description, instead
7393of just the name of the type.
7394
7395For example, for this variable declaration:
7396
7397@example
7398struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
7399@end example
7400
7401@noindent
7402the two commands give this output:
7403
7404@example
7405@group
7406(@value{GDBP}) whatis v
7407type = struct complex
7408(@value{GDBP}) ptype v
7409type = struct complex @{
7410 double real;
7411 double imag;
7412@}
7413@end group
7414@end example
7415
7416@noindent
7417As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
7418the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
7419
7420@kindex info types
7421@item info types @var{regexp}
7422@itemx info types
d4f3574e 7423Print a brief description of all types whose names match @var{regexp}
c906108c
SS
7424(or all types in your program, if you supply no argument). Each
7425complete typename is matched as though it were a complete line; thus,
7426@samp{i type value} gives information on all types in your program whose
d4f3574e 7427names include the string @code{value}, but @samp{i type ^value$} gives
c906108c
SS
7428information only on types whose complete name is @code{value}.
7429
7430This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
7431@code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
7432lists all source files where a type is defined.
7433
7434@kindex info source
7435@item info source
7436Show the name of the current source file---that is, the source file for
7437the function containing the current point of execution---and the language
7438it was written in.
7439
7440@kindex info sources
7441@item info sources
7442Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
7443debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
7444have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
7445
7446@kindex info functions
7447@item info functions
7448Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
7449
7450@item info functions @var{regexp}
7451Print the names and data types of all defined functions
7452whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
7453Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
7454include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
7455start with @code{step}.
7456
7457@kindex info variables
7458@item info variables
7459Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
7460outside of functions (i.e., excluding local variables).
7461
7462@item info variables @var{regexp}
7463Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
7464variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
7465@var{regexp}.
7466
7467@ignore
7468This was never implemented.
7469@kindex info methods
7470@item info methods
7471@itemx info methods @var{regexp}
7472The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
7473methods within C++ program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
7474specific set of methods found in the various C++ classes. Many
7475C++ classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
7476from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
7477@code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
7478which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
7479@end ignore
7480
c906108c
SS
7481@cindex reloading symbols
7482Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
7a292a7a
SS
7483be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
7484in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
7485running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
7486@value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
c906108c
SS
7487
7488@table @code
7489@kindex set symbol-reloading
7490@item set symbol-reloading on
7491Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
7492object file with a particular name is seen again.
7493
7494@item set symbol-reloading off
6d2ebf8b
SS
7495Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
7496same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
7497running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
7498should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
7499may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
7500several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
7501name.
c906108c
SS
7502
7503@kindex show symbol-reloading
7504@item show symbol-reloading
7505Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
7506@end table
c906108c 7507
c906108c
SS
7508@kindex set opaque-type-resolution
7509@item set opaque-type-resolution on
7510Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
7511declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
7512@code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
7513source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
7514another source file. The default is on.
7515
7516A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
7517the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
7518
7519@item set opaque-type-resolution off
7520Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
7521is printed as follows:
7522@smallexample
7523@{<no data fields>@}
7524@end smallexample
7525
7526@kindex show opaque-type-resolution
7527@item show opaque-type-resolution
7528Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
c906108c
SS
7529
7530@kindex maint print symbols
7531@cindex symbol dump
7532@kindex maint print psymbols
7533@cindex partial symbol dump
7534@item maint print symbols @var{filename}
7535@itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
7536@itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
7537Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
7538These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
7539symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
7540symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
7541collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
7542only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
7543command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
7544use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
7545symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
7546files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
7547@samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
7548required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
7549@xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
7550@value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
7551@end table
7552
6d2ebf8b 7553@node Altering
c906108c
SS
7554@chapter Altering Execution
7555
7556Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
7557find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
7558correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
7559experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
7560program.
7561
7562For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
7a292a7a
SS
7563locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
7564address, or even return prematurely from a function.
c906108c
SS
7565
7566@menu
7567* Assignment:: Assignment to variables
7568* Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
c906108c 7569* Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
c906108c
SS
7570* Returning:: Returning from a function
7571* Calling:: Calling your program's functions
7572* Patching:: Patching your program
7573@end menu
7574
6d2ebf8b 7575@node Assignment
c906108c
SS
7576@section Assignment to variables
7577
7578@cindex assignment
7579@cindex setting variables
7580To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
7581@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
7582
7583@example
7584print x=4
7585@end example
7586
7587@noindent
7588stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
5d161b24 7589value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
c906108c
SS
7590@xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
7591information on operators in supported languages.
c906108c
SS
7592
7593@kindex set variable
7594@cindex variables, setting
7595If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
7596@code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
7597really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
7598not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
7599,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
7600
c906108c
SS
7601If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
7602appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
7603variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
7604to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
7605program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
7606a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
7607command @code{set width}:
7608
7609@example
7610(@value{GDBP}) whatis width
7611type = double
7612(@value{GDBP}) p width
7613$4 = 13
7614(@value{GDBP}) set width=47
7615Invalid syntax in expression.
7616@end example
7617
7618@noindent
7619The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
7620order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
7621
7622@example
7623(@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
7624@end example
53a5351d 7625
c906108c
SS
7626Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
7627with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
7628@code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
7629your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
7630to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
7631the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
7632
7633@example
7634@group
7635(@value{GDBP}) whatis g
7636type = double
7637(@value{GDBP}) p g
7638$1 = 1
7639(@value{GDBP}) set g=4
2df3850c 7640(@value{GDBP}) p g
c906108c
SS
7641$2 = 1
7642(@value{GDBP}) r
7643The program being debugged has been started already.
7644Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
7645Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
6d2ebf8b
SS
7646"/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
7647 Invalid bfd target.
c906108c
SS
7648(@value{GDBP}) show g
7649The current BFD target is "=4".
7650@end group
7651@end example
7652
7653@noindent
7654The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
7655@code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
7656@code{g}, use
7657
7658@example
7659(@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
7660@end example
c906108c
SS
7661
7662@value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
7663freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
7664and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
7665same length or shorter.
7666@comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
7667@comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
7668
7669To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
7670construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
7671(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
7672to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
7673and representation in memory), and
7674
7675@example
7676set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
7677@end example
7678
7679@noindent
7680stores the value 4 into that memory location.
7681
6d2ebf8b 7682@node Jumping
c906108c
SS
7683@section Continuing at a different address
7684
7685Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
7686it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
7687an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
7688
7689@table @code
7690@kindex jump
7691@item jump @var{linespec}
7692Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
7693immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
7694source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
7695@var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
7696in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
7697breakpoints}.
7698
7699The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
7700the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
7701register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
7702a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
7703be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
7704of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
7705confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
7706executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
7707well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
7708
7709@item jump *@var{address}
7710Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
7711@end table
7712
c906108c 7713@c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
53a5351d
JM
7714On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
7715command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
7716difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
7717changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
7718example,
c906108c
SS
7719
7720@example
7721set $pc = 0x485
7722@end example
7723
7724@noindent
7725makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
7726address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
7727@xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
c906108c
SS
7728
7729The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
7730up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
7731that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
7732detail.
7733
c906108c 7734@c @group
6d2ebf8b 7735@node Signaling
c906108c
SS
7736@section Giving your program a signal
7737
7738@table @code
7739@kindex signal
7740@item signal @var{signal}
7741Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
7742signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
7743signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
7744SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
7745
7746Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
7747giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
7748a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
7749@code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
7750signal.
7751
7752@code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
7753after executing the command.
7754@end table
7755@c @end group
7756
7757Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
7758@code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
7759causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
7760the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
7761passes the signal directly to your program.
7762
c906108c 7763
6d2ebf8b 7764@node Returning
c906108c
SS
7765@section Returning from a function
7766
7767@table @code
7768@cindex returning from a function
7769@kindex return
7770@item return
7771@itemx return @var{expression}
7772You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
7773command. If you give an
7774@var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
7775value.
7776@end table
7777
7778When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
7779(and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
7780discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
7781be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
7782
7783This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
7784frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
7785innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
7786specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
7787of functions.
7788
7789The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
7790program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
7791returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
7792and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
7793selected stack frame returns naturally.
7794
6d2ebf8b 7795@node Calling
c906108c
SS
7796@section Calling program functions
7797
7798@cindex calling functions
7799@kindex call
7800@table @code
7801@item call @var{expr}
7802Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
7803returned values.
7804@end table
7805
7806You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
7807execute a function from your program, but without cluttering the output
5d161b24
DB
7808with @code{void} returned values. If the result is not void, it
7809is printed and saved in the value history.
c906108c 7810
c906108c
SS
7811For the A29K, a user-controlled variable @code{call_scratch_address},
7812specifies the location of a scratch area to be used when @value{GDBN}
7813calls a function in the target. This is necessary because the usual
7814method of putting the scratch area on the stack does not work in systems
7815that have separate instruction and data spaces.
c906108c 7816
6d2ebf8b 7817@node Patching
c906108c 7818@section Patching programs
7a292a7a 7819
c906108c
SS
7820@cindex patching binaries
7821@cindex writing into executables
c906108c 7822@cindex writing into corefiles
c906108c 7823
7a292a7a
SS
7824By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
7825executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
7826alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
7827patching your program's binary.
c906108c
SS
7828
7829If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
7830explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
7831want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
7832repairs.
7833
7834@table @code
7835@kindex set write
7836@item set write on
7837@itemx set write off
7a292a7a
SS
7838If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
7839core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
c906108c
SS
7840off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
7841
7842If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
7a292a7a
SS
7843@code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
7844write}, for your new setting to take effect.
c906108c
SS
7845
7846@item show write
7847@kindex show write
7a292a7a
SS
7848Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
7849as well as reading.
c906108c
SS
7850@end table
7851
6d2ebf8b 7852@node GDB Files
c906108c
SS
7853@chapter @value{GDBN} Files
7854
7a292a7a
SS
7855@value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
7856both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
7857program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
7858@value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
c906108c
SS
7859
7860@menu
7861* Files:: Commands to specify files
7862* Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
7863@end menu
7864
6d2ebf8b 7865@node Files
c906108c 7866@section Commands to specify files
c906108c 7867
7a292a7a 7868@cindex symbol table
c906108c 7869@cindex core dump file
7a292a7a
SS
7870
7871You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
7872way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
7873@value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
7874Out of @value{GDBN}}).
c906108c
SS
7875
7876Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
7877@value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to specify
7878a file you want to use. In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands
7879to specify new files are useful.
7880
7881@table @code
7882@cindex executable file
7883@kindex file
7884@item file @var{filename}
7885Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
7886symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
7887executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
5d161b24
DB
7888directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
7889@value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
7890directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
7891to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
7892and your program, using the @code{path} command.
7893
6d2ebf8b 7894On systems with memory-mapped files, an auxiliary file named
c906108c
SS
7895@file{@var{filename}.syms} may hold symbol table information for
7896@var{filename}. If so, @value{GDBN} maps in the symbol table from
7897@file{@var{filename}.syms}, starting up more quickly. See the
7898descriptions of the file options @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow}
7899(available on the command line, and with the commands @code{file},
5d161b24 7900@code{symbol-file}, or @code{add-symbol-file}, described below),
c906108c 7901for more information.
c906108c
SS
7902
7903@item file
7904@code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
7905has on both executable file and the symbol table.
7906
7907@kindex exec-file
7908@item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
7909Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
7910in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
7911if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
7912discard information on the executable file.
7913
7914@kindex symbol-file
7915@item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
7916Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
7917searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
7918table and program to run from the same file.
7919
7920@code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
7921program's symbol table.
7922
5d161b24 7923The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents
c906108c
SS
7924of its convenience variables, the value history, and all breakpoints and
7925auto-display expressions. This is because they may contain pointers to
7926the internal data recording symbols and data types, which are part of
7927the old symbol table data being discarded inside @value{GDBN}.
7928
7929@code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
7930executing it once.
7931
7932When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
7933understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
7934generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
7935other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
c906108c
SS
7936Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
7937using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
7938optimized code.
c906108c
SS
7939
7940For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
7941using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
7942symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
7943quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
7944details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
7945
7946The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
7947start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
7948occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
7949file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
7950pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
7951warnings and messages}.)
7952
c906108c
SS
7953We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
7954symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
7955symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
7956still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
7957in stabs format.
7958
7959@kindex readnow
7960@cindex reading symbols immediately
7961@cindex symbols, reading immediately
7962@kindex mapped
7963@cindex memory-mapped symbol file
7964@cindex saving symbol table
7965@item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
7966@itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
7967You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
7968tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
7969load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
5d161b24 7970entire symbol table available.
c906108c 7971
c906108c
SS
7972If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the
7973@code{mmap} system call, you can use another option, @samp{-mapped}, to
7974cause @value{GDBN} to write the symbols for your program into a reusable
7975file. Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions map in symbol information
7976from this auxiliary symbol file (if the program has not changed), rather
7977than spending time reading the symbol table from the executable
7978program. Using the @samp{-mapped} option has the same effect as
7979starting @value{GDBN} with the @samp{-mapped} command-line option.
7980
7981You can use both options together, to make sure the auxiliary symbol
7982file has all the symbol information for your program.
7983
7984The auxiliary symbol file for a program called @var{myprog} is called
7985@samp{@var{myprog}.syms}. Once this file exists (so long as it is newer
7986than the corresponding executable), @value{GDBN} always attempts to use
7987it when you debug @var{myprog}; no special options or commands are
7988needed.
7989
7990The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where you run
7991@value{GDBN}. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN}
7992symbol table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c
SS
7993
7994@c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
7995@c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
7996@c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
7997@c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
7998@c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
7999@c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
8000@c files.
8001
8002@kindex core
8003@kindex core-file
8004@item core-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
8005Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
8006of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
8007address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
8008executable file itself for other parts.
8009
8010@code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
8011to be used.
8012
8013Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
7a292a7a
SS
8014under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
8015wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
8016the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
c906108c 8017(@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
c906108c 8018
c906108c
SS
8019@kindex add-symbol-file
8020@cindex dynamic linking
8021@item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
8022@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
d167840f 8023@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}
96a2c332
SS
8024The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
8025information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
8026when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
8027into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
8028address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
d167840f
EZ
8029this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
8030of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
8031section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
8032@var{address} as an expression.
c906108c
SS
8033
8034The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
8035originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
96a2c332
SS
8036@code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
8037thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
8038instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
c906108c
SS
8039
8040@code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
8041
8042You can use the @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow} options just as with
8043the @code{symbol-file} command, to change how @value{GDBN} manages the symbol
8044table information for @var{filename}.
8045
8046@kindex add-shared-symbol-file
8047@item add-shared-symbol-file
8048The @code{add-shared-symbol-file} command can be used only under Harris' CXUX
5d161b24
DB
8049operating system for the Motorola 88k. @value{GDBN} automatically looks for
8050shared libraries, however if @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can run
c906108c 8051@code{add-shared-symbol-file}. It takes no arguments.
c906108c 8052
c906108c
SS
8053@kindex section
8054@item section
5d161b24
DB
8055The @code{section} command changes the base address of section SECTION of
8056the exec file to ADDR. This can be used if the exec file does not contain
8057section addresses, (such as in the a.out format), or when the addresses
8058specified in the file itself are wrong. Each section must be changed
d4f3574e
SS
8059separately. The @code{info files} command, described below, lists all
8060the sections and their addresses.
c906108c
SS
8061
8062@kindex info files
8063@kindex info target
8064@item info files
8065@itemx info target
7a292a7a
SS
8066@code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
8067current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
8068including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
8069use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
8070command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
8071current ones.
8072
c906108c
SS
8073@end table
8074
8075All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
8076as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
8077name and remembers it that way.
8078
c906108c 8079@cindex shared libraries
c906108c
SS
8080@value{GDBN} supports HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix 5, and IBM RS/6000 shared
8081libraries.
53a5351d 8082
c906108c
SS
8083@value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
8084when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
8085(Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
8086references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
8087debugging a core file).
53a5351d
JM
8088
8089On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
8090automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
8091
c906108c
SS
8092@c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
8093@c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
8094@c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
8095
8096@table @code
8097@kindex info sharedlibrary
8098@kindex info share
8099@item info share
8100@itemx info sharedlibrary
8101Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
8102
8103@kindex sharedlibrary
8104@kindex share
8105@item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
8106@itemx share @var{regex}
c906108c
SS
8107Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
8108Unix regular expression.
8109As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
8110required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
8111@var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
8112loaded.
8113@end table
8114
53a5351d
JM
8115On HP-UX systems, @value{GDBN} detects the loading of a shared library
8116and automatically reads in symbols from the newly loaded library, up to
8117a threshold that is initially set but that you can modify if you wish.
c906108c
SS
8118
8119Beyond that threshold, symbols from shared libraries must be explicitly
d4f3574e
SS
8120loaded. To load these symbols, use the command @code{sharedlibrary
8121@var{filename}}. The base address of the shared library is determined
c906108c
SS
8122automatically by @value{GDBN} and need not be specified.
8123
8124To display or set the threshold, use the commands:
8125
8126@table @code
8127@kindex set auto-solib-add
8128@item set auto-solib-add @var{threshold}
8129Set the autoloading size threshold, in megabytes. If @var{threshold} is
8130nonzero, symbols from all shared object libraries will be loaded
8131automatically when the inferior begins execution or when the dynamic
8132linker informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded, until
8133the symbol table of the program and libraries exceeds this threshold.
8134Otherwise, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
8135@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default threshold is 100 megabytes.
8136
8137@kindex show auto-solib-add
8138@item show auto-solib-add
8139Display the current autoloading size threshold, in megabytes.
8140@end table
c906108c 8141
6d2ebf8b 8142@node Symbol Errors
c906108c
SS
8143@section Errors reading symbol files
8144
8145While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
8146such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
8147output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
8148they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
8149debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
8150about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
8151only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
8152times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
8153to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
8154complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
8155messages}).
8156
8157The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
8158
8159@table @code
8160@item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
8161
8162The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
8163(such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
8164error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
8165in its outer scope blocks.
8166
8167@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
8168the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
8169may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
8170function.
8171
8172@item block at @var{address} out of order
8173
8174The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
8175order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
8176do so.
8177
8178@value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
8179locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
8180can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
8181@code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
8182messages}.)
8183
8184@item bad block start address patched
8185
8186The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
8187smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
8188to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
8189
8190@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
8191starting on the previous source line.
8192
8193@item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
8194
8195@cindex foo
8196Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
8197larger than the size of the string table.
8198
8199@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
8200name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
8201with this name.
8202
8203@item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
8204
7a292a7a
SS
8205The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
8206not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
d4f3574e 8207uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
c906108c 8208
7a292a7a
SS
8209@value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
8210This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
c906108c 8211are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
7a292a7a
SS
8212debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
8213on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
8214and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
c906108c
SS
8215
8216@item stub type has NULL name
c906108c 8217
7a292a7a 8218@value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
c906108c 8219
7a292a7a 8220@item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
c906108c 8221The symbol information for a C++ member function is missing some
7a292a7a
SS
8222information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
8223it.
c906108c
SS
8224
8225@item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
8226
8227@value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
7a292a7a 8228
c906108c
SS
8229@end table
8230
6d2ebf8b 8231@node Targets
c906108c 8232@chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
7a292a7a 8233
c906108c
SS
8234@cindex debugging target
8235@kindex target
8236
8237A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
53a5351d
JM
8238
8239Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
8240in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
8241you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
c906108c
SS
8242flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
8243host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
53a5351d
JM
8244realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
8245command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
8246(@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
c906108c
SS
8247
8248@menu
8249* Active Targets:: Active targets
8250* Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
c906108c
SS
8251* Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
8252* Remote:: Remote debugging
96baa820 8253* KOD:: Kernel Object Display
c906108c
SS
8254
8255@end menu
8256
6d2ebf8b 8257@node Active Targets
c906108c 8258@section Active targets
7a292a7a 8259
c906108c
SS
8260@cindex stacking targets
8261@cindex active targets
8262@cindex multiple targets
8263
c906108c 8264There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
7a292a7a
SS
8265executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
8266active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
8267start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
8268a core file.
c906108c
SS
8269
8270For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
8271@code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
8272well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
8273@value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
8274first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
8275requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
8276are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
8277read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
8278executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
c906108c
SS
8279
8280When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
7a292a7a
SS
8281target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
8282commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
8283an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
8284process target is active.
c906108c 8285
7a292a7a
SS
8286Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
8287core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
c906108c 8288files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
7a292a7a
SS
8289the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
8290process}).
c906108c 8291
6d2ebf8b 8292@node Target Commands
c906108c
SS
8293@section Commands for managing targets
8294
8295@table @code
8296@item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
7a292a7a
SS
8297Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
8298process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
8299facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
8300protocol of the target machine.
c906108c
SS
8301
8302Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
8303typically include things like device names or host names to connect
8304with, process numbers, and baud rates.
c906108c
SS
8305
8306The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
8307after executing the command.
8308
8309@kindex help target
8310@item help target
8311Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
8312currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
8313(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
8314
8315@item help target @var{name}
8316Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
8317select it.
8318
8319@kindex set gnutarget
8320@item set gnutarget @var{args}
5d161b24 8321@value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
c906108c 8322knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
5d161b24
DB
8323a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
8324with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
c906108c
SS
8325with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
8326
d4f3574e 8327@quotation
c906108c
SS
8328@emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
8329you must know the actual BFD name.
d4f3574e 8330@end quotation
c906108c 8331
d4f3574e
SS
8332@noindent
8333@xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
c906108c 8334
5d161b24 8335@kindex show gnutarget
c906108c
SS
8336@item show gnutarget
8337Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
8338@code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
8339@value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
8340and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
8341@end table
8342
c906108c
SS
8343Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
8344configuration):
c906108c
SS
8345
8346@table @code
8347@kindex target exec
8348@item target exec @var{program}
8349An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
8350@samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
8351
c906108c
SS
8352@kindex target core
8353@item target core @var{filename}
8354A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
8355@samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
c906108c
SS
8356
8357@kindex target remote
8358@item target remote @var{dev}
8359Remote serial target in GDB-specific protocol. The argument @var{dev}
8360specifies what serial device to use for the connection (e.g.
8361@file{/dev/ttya}). @xref{Remote, ,Remote debugging}. @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 8362supports the @code{load} command. This is only useful if you have
c906108c
SS
8363some other way of getting the stub to the target system, and you can put
8364it somewhere in memory where it won't get clobbered by the download.
8365
c906108c
SS
8366@kindex target sim
8367@item target sim
2df3850c 8368Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
104c1213
JM
8369In general,
8370@example
8371 target sim
8372 load
8373 run
8374@end example
d4f3574e 8375@noindent
104c1213 8376works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
d4f3574e 8377drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
104c1213
JM
8378provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
8379see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
8380Processors}.
8381
c906108c
SS
8382@end table
8383
104c1213 8384Some configurations may include these targets as well:
c906108c
SS
8385
8386@table @code
8387
c906108c
SS
8388@kindex target nrom
8389@item target nrom @var{dev}
8390NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
8391
c906108c
SS
8392@end table
8393
5d161b24 8394Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
c906108c 8395your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
c906108c
SS
8396
8397Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code
8398once you've successfully established a connection.
8399
8400@table @code
8401
8402@kindex load @var{filename}
8403@item load @var{filename}
c906108c
SS
8404Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
8405@value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
8406is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
8407on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
8408@code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
8409the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
8410
8411If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
8412execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
8413target is @dots{}}''
c906108c
SS
8414
8415The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
8416For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
8417link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
8418specifies a fixed address.
8419@c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
8420
c906108c
SS
8421@code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
8422@end table
8423
6d2ebf8b 8424@node Byte Order
c906108c 8425@section Choosing target byte order
7a292a7a 8426
c906108c
SS
8427@cindex choosing target byte order
8428@cindex target byte order
c906108c
SS
8429
8430Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Hitachi SH,
8431offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
8432orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
8433designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
8434which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
d4f3574e 8435@value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
c906108c
SS
8436
8437@table @code
8438@kindex set endian big
8439@item set endian big
8440Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
8441
8442@kindex set endian little
8443@item set endian little
8444Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
8445
8446@kindex set endian auto
8447@item set endian auto
8448Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
8449executable.
8450
8451@item show endian
8452Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
8453
8454@end table
8455
8456Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
8457data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
8458target system.
8459
6d2ebf8b 8460@node Remote
c906108c
SS
8461@section Remote debugging
8462@cindex remote debugging
8463
8464If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
5d161b24
DB
8465@value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
8466For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
c906108c
SS
8467or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
8468powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
8469
8470Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
8471to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
5d161b24 8472@value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
c906108c
SS
8473but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
8474write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
8475communicate with @value{GDBN}.
8476
8477Other remote targets may be available in your
8478configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
c906108c 8479
c906108c 8480@menu
c906108c 8481* Remote Serial:: @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol
c906108c
SS
8482@end menu
8483
6d2ebf8b 8484@node Remote Serial
104c1213 8485@subsection The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol
7a292a7a 8486
104c1213
JM
8487@cindex remote serial debugging, overview
8488To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
8489@dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
8490prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
8491program, you need:
c906108c 8492
104c1213
JM
8493@enumerate
8494@item
8495A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
8496have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
8497your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
96baa820 8498
5d161b24 8499@item
d4f3574e 8500A C subroutine library to support your program's
104c1213 8501subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
96baa820 8502
104c1213
JM
8503@item
8504A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
8505download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
8506manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
8507documentation.
8508@end enumerate
96baa820 8509
104c1213
JM
8510The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
8511communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
8512machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
96baa820 8513
104c1213
JM
8514@table @emph
8515@item On the host,
8516@value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
8517else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
8518(@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
8519
8520@item On the target,
8521you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
8522implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
8523subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
8524
8525On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
8526@code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
8527@xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
8528@end table
96baa820 8529
104c1213
JM
8530The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
8531machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
8532@sc{sparc} boards.
96baa820 8533
104c1213
JM
8534@cindex remote serial stub list
8535These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
96baa820 8536
104c1213
JM
8537@table @code
8538
8539@item i386-stub.c
41afff9a 8540@cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
8541@cindex Intel
8542@cindex i386
8543For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
8544
8545@item m68k-stub.c
41afff9a 8546@cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
8547@cindex Motorola 680x0
8548@cindex m680x0
8549For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
8550
8551@item sh-stub.c
41afff9a 8552@cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
8553@cindex Hitachi
8554@cindex SH
8555For Hitachi SH architectures.
8556
8557@item sparc-stub.c
41afff9a 8558@cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
8559@cindex Sparc
8560For @sc{sparc} architectures.
8561
8562@item sparcl-stub.c
41afff9a 8563@cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
8564@cindex Fujitsu
8565@cindex SparcLite
8566For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
8567
8568@end table
8569
8570The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
8571recently added stubs.
8572
8573@menu
8574* Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
8575* Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
8576* Debug Session:: Putting it all together
8577* Protocol:: Definition of the communication protocol
8578* Server:: Using the `gdbserver' program
8579* NetWare:: Using the `gdbserve.nlm' program
8580@end menu
8581
6d2ebf8b 8582@node Stub Contents
104c1213
JM
8583@subsubsection What the stub can do for you
8584
8585@cindex remote serial stub
8586The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
8587subroutines:
8588
8589@table @code
8590@item set_debug_traps
8591@kindex set_debug_traps
8592@cindex remote serial stub, initialization
8593This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
8594program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
8595beginning of your program.
8596
8597@item handle_exception
8598@kindex handle_exception
8599@cindex remote serial stub, main routine
8600This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
8601explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
8602run when a trap is triggered.
8603
8604@code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
8605execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
8606with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
8607protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
d4f3574e 8608representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
104c1213
JM
8609information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
8610retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
8611execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
8612@code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
5d161b24 8613machine.
104c1213
JM
8614
8615@item breakpoint
8616@cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
8617Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
8618breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
8619way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
8620machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
8621pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
8622@code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
8623simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
8624again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
8625your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
5d161b24 8626@value{GDBN} session gets control.
104c1213
JM
8627
8628Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
8629to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
8630start of your debugging session.
8631@end table
8632
6d2ebf8b 8633@node Bootstrapping
104c1213
JM
8634@subsubsection What you must do for the stub
8635
8636@cindex remote stub, support routines
8637The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
8638chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
8639debugging target machine.
8640
8641First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
8642serial port.
8643
8644@table @code
8645@item int getDebugChar()
8646@kindex getDebugChar
8647Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
8648It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
8649different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
8650
8651@item void putDebugChar(int)
8652@kindex putDebugChar
8653Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
5d161b24 8654It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
104c1213
JM
8655different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
8656@end table
8657
8658@cindex control C, and remote debugging
8659@cindex interrupting remote targets
8660If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
8661running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
8662for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
8663character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
8664remote system to stop.
8665
8666Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
8667probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
8668is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
8669@value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
8670
8671Other routines you need to supply are:
8672
8673@table @code
8674@item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
8675@kindex exceptionHandler
8676Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
8677handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
8678way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
8679are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
8680containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
8681@var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
8682its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
8683might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
8684exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
8685@var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
8686and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
8687you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
8688should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
8689
8690For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
8691gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
8692should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
8693@sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
8694help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
8695
8696@item void flush_i_cache()
8697@kindex flush_i_cache
d4f3574e 8698On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
104c1213
JM
8699instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
8700instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
8701
8702On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
8703function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
8704@end table
8705
8706@noindent
8707You must also make sure this library routine is available:
8708
8709@table @code
8710@item void *memset(void *, int, int)
8711@kindex memset
8712This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
8713memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
8714@code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
8715either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
8716@end table
8717
8718If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
8719library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
8720but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
d4f3574e 8721subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
104c1213
JM
8722
8723
6d2ebf8b 8724@node Debug Session
104c1213
JM
8725@subsubsection Putting it all together
8726
8727@cindex remote serial debugging summary
8728In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
8729steps.
8730
8731@enumerate
8732@item
6d2ebf8b 8733Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
104c1213
JM
8734(@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
8735@display
8736@code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
8737@code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
8738@end display
8739
8740@item
8741Insert these lines near the top of your program:
8742
8743@example
8744set_debug_traps();
8745breakpoint();
8746@end example
8747
8748@item
8749For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
8750@code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
8751
8752@example
8753void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
8754@end example
8755
d4f3574e 8756@noindent
104c1213 8757but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
598ca718 8758function in your program, that function is called when
104c1213
JM
8759@code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
8760error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
8761one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
8762
8763@item
8764Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
8765your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
8766
8767@item
8768Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
8769the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
8770
8771@item
8772@c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
8773@c document that. FIXME.
8774Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
8775whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
8776
8777@item
8778To start remote debugging, run @value{GDBN} on the host machine, and specify
8779as an executable file the program that is running in the remote machine.
8780This tells @value{GDBN} how to find your program's symbols and the contents
8781of its pure text.
8782
d4f3574e 8783@item
104c1213 8784@cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 8785Establish communication using the @code{target remote} command.
104c1213
JM
8786Its argument specifies how to communicate with the target
8787machine---either via a devicename attached to a direct serial line, or a
8788TCP port (usually to a terminal server which in turn has a serial line
8789to the target). For example, to use a serial line connected to the
8790device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
8791
8792@example
8793target remote /dev/ttyb
8794@end example
8795
8796@cindex TCP port, @code{target remote}
8797To use a TCP connection, use an argument of the form
8798@code{@var{host}:port}. For example, to connect to port 2828 on a
8799terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
8800
8801@example
8802target remote manyfarms:2828
8803@end example
8804@end enumerate
8805
8806Now you can use all the usual commands to examine and change data and to
8807step and continue the remote program.
8808
8809To resume the remote program and stop debugging it, use the @code{detach}
8810command.
8811
8812@cindex interrupting remote programs
8813@cindex remote programs, interrupting
8814Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
8815interrupt character (often @key{C-C}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
8816program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
8817and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
8818interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
8819
8820@example
8821Interrupted while waiting for the program.
8822Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
8823@end example
8824
8825If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
8826(If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
8827remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
8828goes back to waiting.
8829
6d2ebf8b 8830@node Protocol
104c1213
JM
8831@subsubsection Communication protocol
8832
8833@cindex debugging stub, example
8834@cindex remote stub, example
8835@cindex stub example, remote debugging
8836The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
8837communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
8838@value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
8839these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
8840implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
8841with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
8842organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
8843
8844However, there may be occasions when you need to know something about
8845the protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your
8846target machine, you might want your program to do something special if
8847it recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
8848
8849In the examples below, @samp{<-} and @samp{->} are used to indicate
8850transmitted and received data respectfully.
8851
8852@cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
8853@cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
8854@cindex remote serial protocol
6cf7e474
AC
8855All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
8856sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
8857@samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
8858@samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
104c1213
JM
8859
8860@example
8861@code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
8862@end example
8863@noindent
104c1213
JM
8864
8865@cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
8866@noindent
8867The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
6cf7e474
AC
8868characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
8869eight bit unsigned checksum).
8870
8871Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
8872specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
8873
8874@example
8875@code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
8876@end example
104c1213
JM
8877
8878@cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
8879@noindent
6cf7e474
AC
8880That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
8881has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
8882since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
104c1213 8883
6cf7e474 8884@cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
104c1213
JM
8885When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
8886response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
8887the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
8888retransmission):
8889
8890@example
8891<- @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
8892-> @code{+}
8893@end example
8894@noindent
104c1213
JM
8895
8896The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
8897debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
8898the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
8899when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
8900
8901@var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
6cf7e474
AC
8902exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
8903exceptions).
8904
8905Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
8906@samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
8907HEX with leading zeros suppressed.
8908
8909Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
8910@samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
8911would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
104c1213
JM
8912
8913Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
c3f6f71d 8914means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
104c1213
JM
8915which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
8916@samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
d4f3574e
SS
8917where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
8918characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
8919value greater than 126 should not be used.
8920
8921Some remote systems have used a different run-length encoding mechanism
8922loosely refered to as the cisco encoding. Following the @samp{*}
8923character are two hex digits that indicate the size of the packet.
104c1213
JM
8924
8925So:
8926@example
8927"@code{0* }"
8928@end example
8929@noindent
8930means the same as "0000".
8931
598ca718 8932The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
104c1213
JM
8933error number. That number is not well defined.
8934
8935For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
8936(@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
8937protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
d4f3574e 8938on that response.
104c1213 8939
f1251bdd
C
8940A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
8941@samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
8942optional.
8943
104c1213
JM
8944Below is a complete list of all currently defined @var{command}s and
8945their corresponding response @var{data}:
598ca718 8946@page
104c1213
JM
8947@multitable @columnfractions .30 .30 .40
8948@item Packet
8949@tab Request
8950@tab Description
8951
f1251bdd 8952@item extended ops
104c1213
JM
8953@tab @code{!}
8954@tab
d4f3574e 8955Use the extended remote protocol. Sticky---only needs to be set once.
598ca718 8956The extended remote protocol supports the @samp{R} packet.
104c1213
JM
8957@item
8958@tab reply @samp{}
8959@tab
8960Stubs that support the extended remote protocol return @samp{} which,
8961unfortunately, is identical to the response returned by stubs that do not
8962support protocol extensions.
8963
8964@item last signal
8965@tab @code{?}
8966@tab
d4f3574e
SS
8967Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for step
8968and continue.
8969@item
8970@tab reply
8971@tab see below
8972
104c1213
JM
8973
8974@item reserved
8975@tab @code{a}
5d161b24 8976@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 8977
f1251bdd 8978@item set program arguments @strong{(reserved)}
104c1213
JM
8979@tab @code{A}@var{arglen}@code{,}@var{argnum}@code{,}@var{arg}@code{,...}
8980@tab
598ca718
EZ
8981@item
8982@tab
8983@tab
104c1213
JM
8984Initialized @samp{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
8985specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream @var{arg}.
d4f3574e 8986See @file{gdbserver} for more details.
104c1213
JM
8987@item
8988@tab reply @code{OK}
8989@item
8990@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
8991
8992@item set baud @strong{(deprecated)}
8993@tab @code{b}@var{baud}
8994@tab
8995Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}. JTC: @emph{When does the
8996transport layer state change? When it's received, or after the ACK is
8997transmitted. In either case, there are problems if the command or the
8998acknowledgment packet is dropped.} Stan: @emph{If people really wanted
8999to add something like this, and get it working for the first time, they
9000ought to modify ser-unix.c to send some kind of out-of-band message to a
9001specially-setup stub and have the switch happen "in between" packets, so
9002that from remote protocol's point of view, nothing actually
9003happened.}
9004
9005@item set breakpoint @strong{(deprecated)}
9006@tab @code{B}@var{addr},@var{mode}
9007@tab
9008Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
9009breakpoint at @var{addr}. @emph{This has been replaced by the @samp{Z} and
9010@samp{z} packets.}
9011
9012@item continue
9013@tab @code{c}@var{addr}
9014@tab
9015@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
9016current address.
9017@item
9018@tab reply
9019@tab see below
9020
f1251bdd 9021@item continue with signal
104c1213
JM
9022@tab @code{C}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
9023@tab
9024Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
9025@code{;}@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
9026@item
9027@tab reply
9028@tab see below
9029
598ca718 9030@item toggle debug @strong{(deprecated)}
104c1213
JM
9031@tab @code{d}
9032@tab
d4f3574e 9033toggle debug flag.
104c1213 9034
f1251bdd 9035@item detach
104c1213 9036@tab @code{D}
d4f3574e 9037@tab
2df3850c
JM
9038Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target before
9039@value{GDBN} disconnects.
d4f3574e
SS
9040@item
9041@tab reply @emph{no response}
9042@tab
598ca718 9043@value{GDBN} does not check for any response after sending this packet.
104c1213
JM
9044
9045@item reserved
9046@tab @code{e}
5d161b24 9047@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9048
9049@item reserved
9050@tab @code{E}
5d161b24 9051@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9052
9053@item reserved
9054@tab @code{f}
5d161b24 9055@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9056
9057@item reserved
9058@tab @code{F}
5d161b24 9059@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9060
9061@item read registers
9062@tab @code{g}
9063@tab Read general registers.
9064@item
9065@tab reply @var{XX...}
9066@tab
9067Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
9068with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
d4f3574e 9069each register and their position within the @samp{g} @var{packet} are
2df3850c 9070determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros @var{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and
d4f3574e
SS
9071@var{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The specification of several standard
9072@code{g} packets is specified below.
104c1213
JM
9073@item
9074@tab @code{E}@var{NN}
9075@tab for an error.
9076
9077@item write regs
9078@tab @code{G}@var{XX...}
9079@tab
9080See @samp{g} for a description of the @var{XX...} data.
9081@item
9082@tab reply @code{OK}
9083@tab for success
9084@item
9085@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9086@tab for an error
9087
9088@item reserved
9089@tab @code{h}
5d161b24 9090@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 9091
f1251bdd 9092@item set thread
104c1213
JM
9093@tab @code{H}@var{c}@var{t...}
9094@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9095Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
9096@samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} = @samp{c} for thread used in step and
9097continue; @var{t...} can be -1 for all threads. @var{c} = @samp{g} for
9098thread used in other operations. If zero, pick a thread, any thread.
104c1213
JM
9099@item
9100@tab reply @code{OK}
9101@tab for success
9102@item
9103@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9104@tab for an error
9105
d4f3574e
SS
9106@c FIXME: JTC:
9107@c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
5d161b24 9108@c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
d4f3574e
SS
9109@c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
9110@c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
9111@c described. For example:
9112@c
9113@c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
9114@c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
9115@c otherwise returns current registers.
9116@c
9117@c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
9118@c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
9119@c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
9120
f1251bdd 9121@item cycle step @strong{(draft)}
104c1213
JM
9122@tab @code{i}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{nnn}
9123@tab
9124Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @code{,}@var{nnn} is
9125present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
9126step starting at that address.
9127
f1251bdd 9128@item signal then cycle step @strong{(reserved)}
104c1213
JM
9129@tab @code{I}
9130@tab
9131See @samp{i} and @samp{S} for likely syntax and semantics.
9132
9133@item reserved
9134@tab @code{j}
9135@tab Reserved for future use
9136
9137@item reserved
9138@tab @code{J}
5d161b24 9139@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 9140
f1251bdd 9141@item kill request
104c1213
JM
9142@tab @code{k}
9143@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9144FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how operate when a specific
9145thread context has been selected (ie. does 'k' kill only that thread?)}.
104c1213
JM
9146
9147@item reserved
9148@tab @code{l}
5d161b24 9149@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9150
9151@item reserved
9152@tab @code{L}
5d161b24 9153@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9154
9155@item read memory
9156@tab @code{m}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9157@tab
9158Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
2df3850c 9159Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that sized memory transfers are assumed
d4f3574e
SS
9160using word alligned accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory
9161transfer mechanism is needed.}
104c1213
JM
9162@item
9163@tab reply @var{XX...}
9164@tab
d4f3574e 9165@var{XX...} is mem contents. Can be fewer bytes than requested if able
2df3850c 9166to read only part of the data. Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that
d4f3574e
SS
9167sized memory transfers are assumed using word alligned accesses. FIXME:
9168@emph{A word aligned memory transfer mechanism is needed.}
104c1213
JM
9169@item
9170@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9171@tab @var{NN} is errno
9172
9173@item write mem
9174@tab @code{M}@var{addr},@var{length}@code{:}@var{XX...}
9175@tab
9176Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
9177@var{XX...} is the data.
9178@item
9179@tab reply @code{OK}
9180@tab for success
9181@item
9182@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9183@tab
9184for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
9185written).
9186
9187@item reserved
9188@tab @code{n}
5d161b24 9189@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9190
9191@item reserved
9192@tab @code{N}
5d161b24 9193@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9194
9195@item reserved
9196@tab @code{o}
5d161b24 9197@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9198
9199@item reserved
9200@tab @code{O}
5d161b24 9201@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9202
9203@item read reg @strong{(reserved)}
9204@tab @code{p}@var{n...}
9205@tab
9206See write register.
9207@item
9208@tab return @var{r....}
9209@tab The hex encoded value of the register in target byte order.
9210
f1251bdd 9211@item write reg
104c1213
JM
9212@tab @code{P}@var{n...}@code{=}@var{r...}
9213@tab
9214Write register @var{n...} with value @var{r...}, which contains two hex
9215digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
9216@item
9217@tab reply @code{OK}
9218@tab for success
9219@item
9220@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9221@tab for an error
9222
f1251bdd 9223@item general query
104c1213
JM
9224@tab @code{q}@var{query}
9225@tab
598ca718 9226Request info about @var{query}. In general @value{GDBN} queries
104c1213 9227have a leading upper case letter. Custom vendor queries should use a
d4f3574e
SS
9228company prefix (in lower case) ex: @samp{qfsf.var}. @var{query} may
9229optionally be followed by a @samp{,} or @samp{;} separated list. Stubs
9230must ensure that they match the full @var{query} name.
104c1213
JM
9231@item
9232@tab reply @code{XX...}
d4f3574e 9233@tab Hex encoded data from query. The reply can not be empty.
104c1213
JM
9234@item
9235@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9236@tab error reply
9237@item
9238@tab reply @samp{}
9239@tab Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
9240
f1251bdd 9241@item general set
104c1213
JM
9242@tab @code{Q}@var{var}@code{=}@var{val}
9243@tab
9244Set value of @var{var} to @var{val}. See @samp{q} for a discussing of
9245naming conventions.
9246
598ca718 9247@item reset @strong{(deprecated)}
d4f3574e
SS
9248@tab @code{r}
9249@tab
9250Reset the entire system.
104c1213 9251
f1251bdd 9252@item remote restart
104c1213
JM
9253@tab @code{R}@var{XX}
9254@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9255Restart the remote server. @var{XX} while needed has no clear
9256definition. FIXME: @emph{An example interaction explaining how this
9257packet is used in extended-remote mode is needed}.
104c1213 9258
f1251bdd 9259@item step
104c1213
JM
9260@tab @code{s}@var{addr}
9261@tab
9262@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
9263same address.
9264@item
9265@tab reply
9266@tab see below
9267
f1251bdd 9268@item step with signal
104c1213
JM
9269@tab @code{S}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
9270@tab
9271Like @samp{C} but step not continue.
9272@item
9273@tab reply
9274@tab see below
9275
f1251bdd 9276@item search
104c1213
JM
9277@tab @code{t}@var{addr}@code{:}@var{PP}@code{,}@var{MM}
9278@tab
9279Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
9280@var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4
d4f3574e 9281bytes. @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
104c1213 9282
f1251bdd 9283@item thread alive
104c1213
JM
9284@tab @code{T}@var{XX}
9285@tab Find out if the thread XX is alive.
9286@item
9287@tab reply @code{OK}
9288@tab thread is still alive
9289@item
9290@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9291@tab thread is dead
5d161b24 9292
104c1213
JM
9293@item reserved
9294@tab @code{u}
5d161b24 9295@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9296
9297@item reserved
9298@tab @code{U}
5d161b24 9299@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9300
9301@item reserved
9302@tab @code{v}
5d161b24 9303@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9304
9305@item reserved
9306@tab @code{V}
5d161b24 9307@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9308
9309@item reserved
9310@tab @code{w}
5d161b24 9311@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9312
9313@item reserved
9314@tab @code{W}
5d161b24 9315@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9316
9317@item reserved
9318@tab @code{x}
5d161b24 9319@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 9320
f1251bdd 9321@item write mem (binary)
104c1213
JM
9322@tab @code{X}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}@var{:}@var{XX...}
9323@tab
9324@var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes, @var{XX...} is
d4f3574e
SS
9325binary data. The characters @code{$}, @code{#}, and @code{0x7d} are
9326escaped using @code{0x7d}.
104c1213
JM
9327@item
9328@tab reply @code{OK}
9329@tab for success
9330@item
9331@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9332@tab for an error
9333
9334@item reserved
9335@tab @code{y}
5d161b24 9336@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9337
9338@item reserved
9339@tab @code{Y}
5d161b24 9340@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 9341
f1251bdd 9342@item remove break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
104c1213
JM
9343@tab @code{z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9344@tab
9345See @samp{Z}.
9346
f1251bdd 9347@item insert break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
104c1213
JM
9348@tab @code{Z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9349@tab
9350@var{t} is type: @samp{0} - software breakpoint, @samp{1} - hardware
9351breakpoint, @samp{2} - write watchpoint, @samp{3} - read watchpoint,
9352@samp{4} - access watchpoint; @var{addr} is address; @var{length} is in
9353bytes. For a software breakpoint, @var{length} specifies the size of
9354the instruction to be patched. For hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
d4f3574e
SS
9355@var{length} specifies the memory region to be monitored. To avoid
9356potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should be
6d2ebf8b 9357implemented in an idempotent way.
104c1213
JM
9358@item
9359@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9360@tab for an error
9361@item
9362@tab reply @code{OK}
9363@tab for success
9364@item
9365@tab @samp{}
9366@tab If not supported.
9367
9368@item reserved
9369@tab <other>
5d161b24 9370@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9371
9372@end multitable
9373
d4f3574e
SS
9374The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
9375receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
9376@samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
9377when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @samp{signal
9378number} is poorly defined. In general one of the UNIX signal numbering
9379conventions is used.
104c1213
JM
9380
9381@multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
9382
9383@item @code{S}@var{AA}
9384@tab @var{AA} is the signal number
9385
9386@item @code{T}@var{AA}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}
9387@tab
9388@var{AA} = two hex digit signal number; @var{n...} = register number
9389(hex), @var{r...} = target byte ordered register contents, size defined
9390by @code{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}; @var{n...} = @samp{thread}, @var{r...} =
9391thread process ID, this is a hex integer; @var{n...} = other string not
d4f3574e 9392starting with valid hex digit. @value{GDBN} should ignore this
104c1213
JM
9393@var{n...}, @var{r...} pair and go on to the next. This way we can
9394extend the protocol.
9395
9396@item @code{W}@var{AA}
9397@tab
9398The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
9399applicable for certains sorts of targets.
9400
9401@item @code{X}@var{AA}
9402@tab
9403The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
9404
6d2ebf8b 9405@item @code{N}@var{AA}@code{;}@var{t...}@code{;}@var{d...}@code{;}@var{b...} @strong{(obsolete)}
104c1213 9406@tab
6d2ebf8b
SS
9407@var{AA} = signal number; @var{t...} = address of symbol "_start";
9408@var{d...} = base of data section; @var{b...} = base of bss section.
9409@emph{Note: only used by Cisco Systems targets. The difference between
9410this reply and the "qOffsets" query is that the 'N' packet may arrive
9411spontaneously whereas the 'qOffsets' is a query initiated by the host
9412debugger.}
104c1213
JM
9413
9414@item @code{O}@var{XX...}
9415@tab
c3f6f71d 9416@var{XX...} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data. This can happen at any time
104c1213
JM
9417while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
9418for 'W', 'T', etc.
9419
9420@end multitable
9421
d4f3574e
SS
9422The following set and query packets have already been defined.
9423
9424@multitable @columnfractions .2 .2 .6
9425
9426@item current thread
9427@tab @code{q}@code{C}
9428@tab Return the current thread id.
9429@item
9430@tab reply @code{QC}@var{pid}
9431@tab
9432Where @var{pid} is a HEX encoded 16 bit process id.
9433@item
9434@tab reply *
9435@tab Any other reply implies the old pid.
9436
bba2971c
MS
9437@item all thread ids
9438@tab @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo}
9439@item
9440@tab @code{q}@code{sThreadInfo}
d4f3574e 9441@tab
bba2971c
MS
9442Obtain a list of active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
9443may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
9444works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
9445obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
5d161b24 9446be the @code{qf}@code{ThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
bba2971c 9447sequence will be the @code{qs}@code{ThreadInfo} query.
d4f3574e 9448@item
bba2971c
MS
9449@tab
9450@tab NOTE: replaces the @code{qL} query (see below).
d4f3574e 9451@item
5d161b24 9452@tab reply @code{m}@var{<id>}
bba2971c
MS
9453@tab A single thread id
9454@item
00e4a2e4 9455@tab reply @code{m}@var{<id>},@var{<id>...}
bba2971c
MS
9456@tab a comma-separated list of thread ids
9457@item
9458@tab reply @code{l}
9459@tab (lower case 'el') denotes end of list.
9460@item
9461@tab
9462@tab
9463In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one
9464or more thread ids, in big-endian hex, separated by commas. GDB will
9465respond to each reply with a request for more thread ids (using the
9466@code{qs} form of the query), until the target responds with @code{l}
9467(lower-case el, for @code{'last'}).
9468
9469@item extra thread info
480ff1fb 9470@tab @code{q}@code{ThreadExtraInfo}@code{,}@var{id}
bba2971c
MS
9471@tab
9472@item
9473@tab
9474@tab
9475Where @var{<id>} is a thread-id in big-endian hex.
9476Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
9477the target OS. This string may contain anything that the target OS
9478thinks is interesting for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread.
9479The string is displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @samp{info threads} display.
5d161b24 9480Some examples of possible thread extra info strings are "Runnable", or
bba2971c
MS
9481"Blocked on Mutex".
9482@item
9483@tab reply @var{XX...}
9484@tab
9485Where @var{XX...} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, comprising the
9486printable string containing the extra information about the thread's
9487attributes.
d4f3574e
SS
9488
9489@item query @var{LIST} or @var{threadLIST} @strong{(deprecated)}
9490@tab @code{q}@code{L}@var{startflag}@var{threadcount}@var{nextthread}
9491@tab
2b628194
MS
9492@item
9493@tab
9494@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9495Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
9496digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
9497subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
9498number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
9499(eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
9500returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
9501@item
bba2971c
MS
9502@tab
9503@tab NOTE: this query is replaced by the @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo}
9504query (see above).
9505@item
d4f3574e
SS
9506@tab reply @code{q}@code{M}@var{count}@var{done}@var{argthread}@var{thread...}
9507@tab
2b628194
MS
9508@item
9509@tab
9510@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9511Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
9512returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
9513and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
9514digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread...} is
9515a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
9516digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
9517
bba2971c
MS
9518@item compute CRC of memory block
9519@tab @code{q}@code{CRC:}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9520@tab
9521@item
9522@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9523@tab An error (such as memory fault)
9524@item
9525@tab reply @code{C}@var{CRC32}
9526@tab A 32 bit cyclic redundancy check of the specified memory region.
9527
d4f3574e
SS
9528@item query sect offs
9529@tab @code{q}@code{Offsets}
917317f4
JM
9530@tab
9531Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
9532image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
9533response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
9534offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
d4f3574e
SS
9535@item
9536@tab reply @code{Text=}@var{xxx}@code{;Data=}@var{yyy}@code{;Bss=}@var{zzz}
9537
9538@item thread info request
9539@tab @code{q}@code{P}@var{mode}@var{threadid}
9540@tab
598ca718
EZ
9541@item
9542@tab
9543@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9544Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
9545encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
9546@item
9547@tab reply *
9548@tab
9549See @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
9550
9551@item remote command
9552@tab @code{q}@code{Rcmd,}@var{COMMAND}
9553@tab
598ca718
EZ
9554@item
9555@tab
9556@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9557@var{COMMAND} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
9558execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output string.
9559Before the final result packet, the target may also respond with a
9560number of intermediate @code{O}@var{OUTPUT} console output
9561packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
9562stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
9563@item
9564@tab reply @code{OK}
9565@tab
9566A command response with no output.
9567@item
9568@tab reply @var{OUTPUT}
9569@tab
9570A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
9571@item
9572@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9573@tab
9574Indicate a badly formed request.
9575
9576@item
9577@tab reply @samp{}
9578@tab
9579When @samp{q}@samp{Rcmd} is not recognized.
9580
9581@end multitable
9582
9583The following @samp{g}/@samp{G} packets have previously been defined.
9584In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as sixty-four
9585bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?) to fill the
9586space allocated. Register bytes are transfered in target byte order.
9587The two nibbles within a register byte are transfered most-significant -
9588least-significant.
9589
9590@multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
9591
9592@item MIPS32
9593@tab
9594All registers are transfered as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
959532 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
9596registers; fsr; fir; fp.
9597
9598@item MIPS64
9599@tab
9600All registers are transfered as sixty-four bit quantities (including
9601thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
9602as @code{MIPS32}.
9603
9604@end multitable
9605
104c1213
JM
9606Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
9607does not get any direct output:
9608
9609@example
9610<- @code{R00}
9611-> @code{+}
9612@emph{target restarts}
9613<- @code{?}
9614-> @code{+}
9615-> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
9616<- @code{+}
9617@end example
9618
9619Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
9620
9621@example
9622<- @code{G1445...}
9623-> @code{+}
9624<- @code{s}
9625-> @code{+}
9626@emph{time passes}
9627-> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
9628<- @code{+}
9629<- @code{g}
9630-> @code{+}
9631-> @code{1455...}
9632<- @code{+}
9633@end example
9634
6d2ebf8b 9635@node Server
104c1213
JM
9636@subsubsection Using the @code{gdbserver} program
9637
9638@kindex gdbserver
9639@cindex remote connection without stubs
9640@code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
9641allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
9642@code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
9643
9644@code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
9645because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
9646that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
9647@code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
9648@value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
9649because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
9650also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
9651started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
9652Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
9653the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
9654do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
9655by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
9656choice for debugging.
9657
9658@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
9659or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
9660protocol.
9661
9662@table @emph
9663@item On the target machine,
9664you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
9665@code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
9666strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
9667system does all the symbol handling.
9668
9669To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
9670the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The
9671syntax is:
9672
9673@smallexample
9674target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
9675@end smallexample
9676
9677@var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
9678hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
9679@samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
9680@file{/dev/com1}:
9681
9682@smallexample
9683target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
9684@end smallexample
9685
9686@code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
9687with it.
9688
9689To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
9690
9691@smallexample
9692target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
9693@end smallexample
9694
9695The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
9696specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
9697TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
9698expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
9699(Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
9700you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
9701TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
9702reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
9703conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
d4f3574e 9704and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
104c1213
JM
9705@code{target remote} command.
9706
9707@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
9708you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
9709symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
9710using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
9711(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
d4f3574e 9712running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}.) After that, use @code{target
104c1213
JM
9713remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserver}. Its argument
9714is either a device name (usually a serial device, like
9715@file{/dev/ttyb}), or a TCP port descriptor in the form
9716@code{@var{host}:@var{PORT}}. For example:
9717
9718@smallexample
9719(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
9720@end smallexample
9721
9722@noindent
9723communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and
9724
9725@smallexample
9726(@value{GDBP}) target remote the-target:2345
9727@end smallexample
9728
9729@noindent
9730communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host @w{@file{the-target}}.
9731For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
9732the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
9733text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
9734@samp{Connection refused}.
9735@end table
9736
6d2ebf8b 9737@node NetWare
104c1213
JM
9738@subsubsection Using the @code{gdbserve.nlm} program
9739
9740@kindex gdbserve.nlm
9741@code{gdbserve.nlm} is a control program for NetWare systems, which
9742allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
9743@code{target remote}.
9744
9745@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserve.nlm} communicate via a serial line,
9746using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.
9747
9748@table @emph
9749@item On the target machine,
9750you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
9751@code{gdbserve.nlm} does not need your program's symbol table, so you
9752can strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the
9753host system does all the symbol handling.
9754
9755To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with
9756@value{GDBN}; the name of your program; and the arguments for your
9757program. The syntax is:
9758
5d161b24 9759@smallexample
104c1213
JM
9760load gdbserve [ BOARD=@var{board} ] [ PORT=@var{port} ]
9761 [ BAUD=@var{baud} ] @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
9762@end smallexample
9763
9764@var{board} and @var{port} specify the serial line; @var{baud} specifies
9765the baud rate used by the connection. @var{port} and @var{node} default
d4f3574e 9766to 0, @var{baud} defaults to 9600@dmn{bps}.
104c1213
JM
9767
9768For example, to debug Emacs with the argument @samp{foo.txt}and
5d161b24 9769communicate with @value{GDBN} over serial port number 2 or board 1
d4f3574e 9770using a 19200@dmn{bps} connection:
104c1213
JM
9771
9772@smallexample
9773load gdbserve BOARD=1 PORT=2 BAUD=19200 emacs foo.txt
9774@end smallexample
9775
9776@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
9777you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
9778symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
9779using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
9780(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
d4f3574e 9781running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}. After that, use @code{target
104c1213
JM
9782remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserve.nlm}. Its
9783argument is a device name (usually a serial device, like
9784@file{/dev/ttyb}). For example:
9785
9786@smallexample
9787(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
9788@end smallexample
9789
9790@noindent
9791communications with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}.
9792@end table
9793
6d2ebf8b 9794@node KOD
104c1213
JM
9795@section Kernel Object Display
9796
9797@cindex kernel object display
9798@cindex kernel object
9799@cindex KOD
9800
9801Some targets support kernel object display. Using this facility,
9802@value{GDBN} communicates specially with the underlying operating system
9803and can display information about operating system-level objects such as
9804mutexes and other synchronization objects. Exactly which objects can be
9805displayed is determined on a per-OS basis.
9806
9807Use the @code{set os} command to set the operating system. This tells
9808@value{GDBN} which kernel object display module to initialize:
9809
9810@example
2df3850c 9811(@value{GDBP}) set os cisco
104c1213
JM
9812@end example
9813
9814If @code{set os} succeeds, @value{GDBN} will display some information
9815about the operating system, and will create a new @code{info} command
9816which can be used to query the target. The @code{info} command is named
9817after the operating system:
9818
9819@example
2df3850c 9820(@value{GDBP}) info cisco
104c1213
JM
9821List of Cisco Kernel Objects
9822Object Description
9823any Any and all objects
9824@end example
9825
9826Further subcommands can be used to query about particular objects known
9827by the kernel.
9828
9829There is currently no way to determine whether a given operating system
96baa820
JM
9830is supported other than to try it.
9831
9832
6d2ebf8b 9833@node Configurations
104c1213
JM
9834@chapter Configuration-Specific Information
9835
9836While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
9837cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
9838describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
9839
9840There are three major categories of configurations: native
9841configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
9842operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
9843different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
9844are quite different from each other.
9845
9846@menu
9847* Native::
9848* Embedded OS::
9849* Embedded Processors::
9850* Architectures::
9851@end menu
9852
6d2ebf8b 9853@node Native
104c1213
JM
9854@section Native
9855
9856This section describes details specific to particular native
9857configurations.
9858
9859@menu
9860* HP-UX:: HP-UX
9861* SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
9862@end menu
9863
6d2ebf8b 9864@node HP-UX
104c1213
JM
9865@subsection HP-UX
9866
9867On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
9868begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
9869name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
9870
6d2ebf8b 9871@node SVR4 Process Information
104c1213
JM
9872@subsection SVR4 process information
9873
9874@kindex /proc
9875@cindex process image
9876
9877Many versions of SVR4 provide a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
9878used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
9879subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with
9880this facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report on
9881several kinds of information about the process running your program.
9882@code{info proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the
9883@code{procfs} code. This includes OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, Irix,
9884and Unixware, but not HP-UX or Linux, for example.
9885
9886@table @code
9887@kindex info proc
9888@item info proc
9889Summarize available information about the process.
9890
9891@kindex info proc mappings
9892@item info proc mappings
9893Report on the address ranges accessible in the program, with information
9894on whether your program may read, write, or execute each range.
9895
9896@kindex info proc times
9897@item info proc times
9898Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
9899its children.
9900
9901@kindex info proc id
9902@item info proc id
9903Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
9904the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
9905
9906@kindex info proc status
9907@item info proc status
9908General information on the state of the process. If the process is
9909stopped, this report includes the reason for stopping, and any signal
9910received.
9911
9912@item info proc all
9913Show all the above information about the process.
9914@end table
9915
6d2ebf8b 9916@node Embedded OS
104c1213
JM
9917@section Embedded Operating Systems
9918
9919This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
9920embedded operating systems that are available for several different
9921architectures.
9922
9923@menu
9924* VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
9925@end menu
9926
9927@value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
9928various real-time operating systems.
9929
6d2ebf8b 9930@node VxWorks
104c1213
JM
9931@subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
9932
9933@cindex VxWorks
9934
9935@table @code
9936
9937@kindex target vxworks
9938@item target vxworks @var{machinename}
9939A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
9940is the target system's machine name or IP address.
9941
9942@end table
9943
9944On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
9945current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
9946
9947@value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
9948VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
9949the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
9950both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
d4f3574e 9951@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
104c1213 9952installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
96a2c332 9953@value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
104c1213
JM
9954
9955@table @code
9956@item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
9957@kindex vxworks-timeout
5d161b24
DB
9958All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
9959This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
9960seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
9961your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
104c1213
JM
9962of a thin network line.
9963@end table
9964
9965The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
9966this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
9967procedures.
9968
9969@kindex INCLUDE_RDB
9970To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
9971to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
9972library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
9973VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
9974kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
9975source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
9976information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
9977manual.
9978@c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
9979
9980Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
9981your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
96a2c332
SS
9982run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
9983@code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
104c1213
JM
9984
9985@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
9986
9987@example
9988(vxgdb)
9989@end example
9990
9991@menu
9992* VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
9993* VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
9994* VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
9995@end menu
9996
6d2ebf8b 9997@node VxWorks Connection
104c1213
JM
9998@subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
9999
10000The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
10001network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
10002
10003@example
10004(vxgdb) target vxworks tt
10005@end example
10006
10007@need 750
10008@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
10009
10010@smallexample
5d161b24 10011Attaching remote machine across net...
104c1213
JM
10012Connected to tt.
10013@end smallexample
10014
10015@need 1000
10016@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
10017loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
10018these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
10019path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
10020to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
10021
10022@example
10023prog.o: No such file or directory.
10024@end example
10025
10026When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
10027the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
10028command again.
10029
6d2ebf8b 10030@node VxWorks Download
104c1213
JM
10031@subsubsection VxWorks download
10032
10033@cindex download to VxWorks
10034If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
10035object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
10036@code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
10037incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
10038command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
10039to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
10040table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
10041the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
10042filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
10043Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
10044to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
10045the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
10046@file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
10047and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
10048program, type this on VxWorks:
10049
10050@example
10051-> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
10052@end example
d4f3574e
SS
10053
10054@noindent
104c1213
JM
10055Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
10056
10057@example
5d161b24 10058(vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
104c1213
JM
10059(vxgdb) load prog.o
10060@end example
10061
10062@value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
10063
10064@smallexample
10065Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
10066@end smallexample
10067
10068You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
10069after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
10070this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
10071auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
10072history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
d4f3574e 10073debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
104c1213
JM
10074table.)
10075
6d2ebf8b 10076@node VxWorks Attach
104c1213
JM
10077@subsubsection Running tasks
10078
10079@cindex running VxWorks tasks
10080You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
10081follows:
10082
10083@example
10084(vxgdb) attach @var{task}
10085@end example
10086
10087@noindent
10088where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
10089or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
10090the time of attachment.
10091
6d2ebf8b 10092@node Embedded Processors
104c1213
JM
10093@section Embedded Processors
10094
10095This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
10096configurations.
10097
10098@menu
10099* A29K Embedded:: AMD A29K Embedded
10100* ARM:: ARM
10101* H8/300:: Hitachi H8/300
10102* H8/500:: Hitachi H8/500
10103* i960:: Intel i960
10104* M32R/D:: Mitsubishi M32R/D
10105* M68K:: Motorola M68K
10106* M88K:: Motorola M88K
10107* MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
10108* PA:: HP PA Embedded
10109* PowerPC: PowerPC
10110* SH:: Hitachi SH
10111* Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
10112* Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
10113* ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
10114* Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
10115@end menu
10116
6d2ebf8b 10117@node A29K Embedded
104c1213
JM
10118@subsection AMD A29K Embedded
10119
10120@menu
10121* A29K UDI::
10122* A29K EB29K::
10123* Comms (EB29K):: Communications setup
10124* gdb-EB29K:: EB29K cross-debugging
10125* Remote Log:: Remote log
10126@end menu
10127
10128@table @code
10129
10130@kindex target adapt
10131@item target adapt @var{dev}
10132Adapt monitor for A29K.
10133
10134@kindex target amd-eb
10135@item target amd-eb @var{dev} @var{speed} @var{PROG}
10136@cindex AMD EB29K
10137Remote PC-resident AMD EB29K board, attached over serial lines.
10138@var{dev} is the serial device, as for @code{target remote};
10139@var{speed} allows you to specify the linespeed; and @var{PROG} is the
10140name of the program to be debugged, as it appears to DOS on the PC.
10141@xref{A29K EB29K, ,EBMON protocol for AMD29K}.
10142
10143@end table
10144
6d2ebf8b 10145@node A29K UDI
104c1213
JM
10146@subsubsection A29K UDI
10147
10148@cindex UDI
10149@cindex AMD29K via UDI
10150
10151@value{GDBN} supports AMD's UDI (``Universal Debugger Interface'')
10152protocol for debugging the a29k processor family. To use this
10153configuration with AMD targets running the MiniMON monitor, you need the
10154program @code{MONTIP}, available from AMD at no charge. You can also
10155use @value{GDBN} with the UDI-conformant a29k simulator program
10156@code{ISSTIP}, also available from AMD.
10157
10158@table @code
10159@item target udi @var{keyword}
10160@kindex udi
10161Select the UDI interface to a remote a29k board or simulator, where
10162@var{keyword} is an entry in the AMD configuration file @file{udi_soc}.
10163This file contains keyword entries which specify parameters used to
10164connect to a29k targets. If the @file{udi_soc} file is not in your
10165working directory, you must set the environment variable @samp{UDICONF}
10166to its pathname.
10167@end table
10168
6d2ebf8b 10169@node A29K EB29K
104c1213
JM
10170@subsubsection EBMON protocol for AMD29K
10171
10172@cindex EB29K board
10173@cindex running 29K programs
10174
10175AMD distributes a 29K development board meant to fit in a PC, together
10176with a DOS-hosted monitor program called @code{EBMON}. As a shorthand
10177term, this development system is called the ``EB29K''. To use
10178@value{GDBN} from a Unix system to run programs on the EB29K board, you
10179must first connect a serial cable between the PC (which hosts the EB29K
10180board) and a serial port on the Unix system. In the following, we
10181assume you've hooked the cable between the PC's @file{COM1} port and
10182@file{/dev/ttya} on the Unix system.
10183
6d2ebf8b 10184@node Comms (EB29K)
104c1213
JM
10185@subsubsection Communications setup
10186
10187The next step is to set up the PC's port, by doing something like this
10188in DOS on the PC:
10189
10190@example
10191C:\> MODE com1:9600,n,8,1,none
10192@end example
10193
10194@noindent
10195This example---run on an MS DOS 4.0 system---sets the PC port to 9600
10196bps, no parity, eight data bits, one stop bit, and no ``retry'' action;
10197you must match the communications parameters when establishing the Unix
10198end of the connection as well.
10199@c FIXME: Who knows what this "no retry action" crud from the DOS manual may
5d161b24 10200@c mean? It's optional; leave it out? ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
d4f3574e
SS
10201@c
10202@c It's optional, but it's unwise to omit it: who knows what is the
10203@c default value set when the DOS machines boots? "No retry" means that
10204@c the DOS serial device driver won't retry the operation if it fails;
10205@c I understand that this is needed because the GDB serial protocol
10206@c handles any errors and retransmissions itself. ---Eli Zaretskii, 3sep99
104c1213
JM
10207
10208To give control of the PC to the Unix side of the serial line, type
10209the following at the DOS console:
10210
10211@example
10212C:\> CTTY com1
10213@end example
10214
10215@noindent
10216(Later, if you wish to return control to the DOS console, you can use
10217the command @code{CTTY con}---but you must send it over the device that
96a2c332 10218had control, in our example over the @file{COM1} serial line.)
104c1213
JM
10219
10220From the Unix host, use a communications program such as @code{tip} or
10221@code{cu} to communicate with the PC; for example,
10222
10223@example
10224cu -s 9600 -l /dev/ttya
10225@end example
10226
10227@noindent
10228The @code{cu} options shown specify, respectively, the linespeed and the
10229serial port to use. If you use @code{tip} instead, your command line
10230may look something like the following:
10231
10232@example
10233tip -9600 /dev/ttya
10234@end example
10235
10236@noindent
10237Your system may require a different name where we show
10238@file{/dev/ttya} as the argument to @code{tip}. The communications
10239parameters, including which port to use, are associated with the
10240@code{tip} argument in the ``remote'' descriptions file---normally the
10241system table @file{/etc/remote}.
10242@c FIXME: What if anything needs doing to match the "n,8,1,none" part of
10243@c the DOS side's comms setup? cu can support -o (odd
10244@c parity), -e (even parity)---apparently no settings for no parity or
10245@c for character size. Taken from stty maybe...? John points out tip
10246@c can set these as internal variables, eg ~s parity=none; man stty
10247@c suggests that it *might* work to stty these options with stdin or
10248@c stdout redirected... ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
d4f3574e
SS
10249@c
10250@c There's nothing to be done for the "none" part of the DOS MODE
10251@c command. The rest of the parameters should be matched by the
10252@c baudrate, bits, and parity used by the Unix side. ---Eli Zaretskii, 3Sep99
104c1213
JM
10253
10254@kindex EBMON
10255Using the @code{tip} or @code{cu} connection, change the DOS working
10256directory to the directory containing a copy of your 29K program, then
10257start the PC program @code{EBMON} (an EB29K control program supplied
10258with your board by AMD). You should see an initial display from
10259@code{EBMON} similar to the one that follows, ending with the
10260@code{EBMON} prompt @samp{#}---
10261
10262@example
10263C:\> G:
10264
10265G:\> CD \usr\joe\work29k
10266
10267G:\USR\JOE\WORK29K> EBMON
10268Am29000 PC Coprocessor Board Monitor, version 3.0-18
10269Copyright 1990 Advanced Micro Devices, Inc.
10270Written by Gibbons and Associates, Inc.
10271
10272Enter '?' or 'H' for help
10273
10274PC Coprocessor Type = EB29K
10275I/O Base = 0x208
10276Memory Base = 0xd0000
10277
10278Data Memory Size = 2048KB
10279Available I-RAM Range = 0x8000 to 0x1fffff
10280Available D-RAM Range = 0x80002000 to 0x801fffff
10281
10282PageSize = 0x400
10283Register Stack Size = 0x800
10284Memory Stack Size = 0x1800
10285
10286CPU PRL = 0x3
10287Am29027 Available = No
10288Byte Write Available = Yes
10289
10290# ~.
10291@end example
10292
10293Then exit the @code{cu} or @code{tip} program (done in the example by
10294typing @code{~.} at the @code{EBMON} prompt). @code{EBMON} keeps
10295running, ready for @value{GDBN} to take over.
10296
10297For this example, we've assumed what is probably the most convenient
10298way to make sure the same 29K program is on both the PC and the Unix
d4f3574e 10299system: a PC/NFS connection that establishes ``drive @file{G:}'' on the
104c1213
JM
10300PC as a file system on the Unix host. If you do not have PC/NFS or
10301something similar connecting the two systems, you must arrange some
10302other way---perhaps floppy-disk transfer---of getting the 29K program
10303from the Unix system to the PC; @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} download it over the
10304serial line.
10305
6d2ebf8b 10306@node gdb-EB29K
104c1213
JM
10307@subsubsection EB29K cross-debugging
10308
10309Finally, @code{cd} to the directory containing an image of your 29K
10310program on the Unix system, and start @value{GDBN}---specifying as argument the
10311name of your 29K program:
10312
10313@example
10314cd /usr/joe/work29k
10315@value{GDBP} myfoo
10316@end example
10317
10318@need 500
10319Now you can use the @code{target} command:
10320
10321@example
10322target amd-eb /dev/ttya 9600 MYFOO
10323@c FIXME: test above 'target amd-eb' as spelled, with caps! caps are meant to
10324@c emphasize that this is the name as seen by DOS (since I think DOS is
10325@c single-minded about case of letters). ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
10326@end example
10327
10328@noindent
10329In this example, we've assumed your program is in a file called
10330@file{myfoo}. Note that the filename given as the last argument to
10331@code{target amd-eb} should be the name of the program as it appears to DOS.
10332In our example this is simply @code{MYFOO}, but in general it can include
10333a DOS path, and depending on your transfer mechanism may not resemble
10334the name on the Unix side.
10335
10336At this point, you can set any breakpoints you wish; when you are ready
10337to see your program run on the 29K board, use the @value{GDBN} command
10338@code{run}.
10339
10340To stop debugging the remote program, use the @value{GDBN} @code{detach}
10341command.
10342
10343To return control of the PC to its console, use @code{tip} or @code{cu}
10344once again, after your @value{GDBN} session has concluded, to attach to
10345@code{EBMON}. You can then type the command @code{q} to shut down
10346@code{EBMON}, returning control to the DOS command-line interpreter.
d4f3574e 10347Type @kbd{CTTY con} to return command input to the main DOS console,
104c1213
JM
10348and type @kbd{~.} to leave @code{tip} or @code{cu}.
10349
6d2ebf8b 10350@node Remote Log
104c1213 10351@subsubsection Remote log
41afff9a 10352@cindex @file{eb.log}, a log file for EB29K
104c1213
JM
10353@cindex log file for EB29K
10354
10355The @code{target amd-eb} command creates a file @file{eb.log} in the
10356current working directory, to help debug problems with the connection.
10357@file{eb.log} records all the output from @code{EBMON}, including echoes
10358of the commands sent to it. Running @samp{tail -f} on this file in
10359another window often helps to understand trouble with @code{EBMON}, or
10360unexpected events on the PC side of the connection.
10361
6d2ebf8b 10362@node ARM
104c1213
JM
10363@subsection ARM
10364
10365@table @code
10366
10367@kindex target rdi
10368@item target rdi @var{dev}
10369ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
10370use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
10371monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
5d161b24 10372
104c1213
JM
10373@kindex target rdp
10374@item target rdp @var{dev}
10375ARM Demon monitor.
10376
10377@end table
10378
6d2ebf8b 10379@node H8/300
104c1213
JM
10380@subsection Hitachi H8/300
10381
10382@table @code
10383
d4f3574e 10384@kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
104c1213
JM
10385@item target hms @var{dev}
10386A Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
10387Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
10388line and the communications speed used.
10389
d4f3574e 10390@kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
104c1213
JM
10391@item target e7000 @var{dev}
10392E7000 emulator for Hitachi H8 and SH.
10393
d4f3574e
SS
10394@kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
10395@kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
104c1213 10396@item target sh3 @var{dev}
96a2c332 10397@itemx target sh3e @var{dev}
104c1213
JM
10398Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
10399
10400@end table
10401
10402@cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
10403@cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
10404@cindex download to Hitachi SH
10405@cindex Hitachi SH download
10406When you select remote debugging to a Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500
10407board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Hitachi
10408board and also opens it as the current executable target for
10409@value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
10410
10411@value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
5d161b24 10412Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
104c1213
JM
10413
10414@enumerate
10415@item
10416that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
10417for Hitachi microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
10418emulator for the Hitachi SH and the Hitachi 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
2df3850c 10419the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Hitachi SH,
104c1213
JM
10420H8/300, or H8/500.)
10421
10422@item
10423what serial device connects your host to your Hitachi board (the first
10424serial device available on your host is the default).
10425
10426@item
10427what speed to use over the serial device.
10428@end enumerate
10429
10430@menu
10431* Hitachi Boards:: Connecting to Hitachi boards.
10432* Hitachi ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
10433* Hitachi Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros.
10434@end menu
10435
6d2ebf8b 10436@node Hitachi Boards
104c1213
JM
10437@subsubsection Connecting to Hitachi boards
10438
10439@c only for Unix hosts
10440@kindex device
10441@cindex serial device, Hitachi micros
96a2c332 10442Use the special @code{@value{GDBN}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
104c1213
JM
10443need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
10444first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
10445hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
10446
10447@kindex speed
10448@cindex serial line speed, Hitachi micros
96a2c332 10449@code{@value{GDBN}} has another special command to set the communications
104c1213 10450speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
2df3850c 10451hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
d4f3574e
SS
10452the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
10453@w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
104c1213
JM
10454
10455The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
10456use a Unix host to debug your Hitachi microprocessor programs. If you
10457use a DOS host,
10458@value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
10459called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
10460through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
10461to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
10462
10463The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
10464program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
10465sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
10466the Hitachi SH and the H8/500.
10467
10468First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
10469board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
10470port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
10471When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
d4f3574e 10472debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
104c1213
JM
10473for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
10474@code{COM2}.
10475
10476@example
10477C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
10478C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
10479
10480Resident portion of MODE loaded
10481
10482COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
10483
10484@end example
10485
10486@quotation
10487@emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
10488@code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
10489disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
10490your development board.
10491@end quotation
10492
d4f3574e 10493@kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
104c1213
JM
10494Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
10495connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBP}} with
96a2c332 10496the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBN}} prompts
104c1213
JM
10497you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
10498commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
10499cross-debugging to the Hitachi board, and the @code{load} command to
10500download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
10501the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
10502(If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
10503executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
10504@code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
10505itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
10506
10507@smallexample
10508(eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
2df3850c 10509@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
5d161b24 10510 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
104c1213 10511 the conditions.
5d161b24 10512There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
104c1213 10513for details.
2df3850c
JM
10514@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
10515(@value{GDBP}) target hms
104c1213 10516Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
2df3850c 10517(@value{GDBP}) load t.x
104c1213
JM
10518.text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
10519.data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
10520.stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
10521@end smallexample
10522
10523At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
10524you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
10525sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
10526@code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
10527resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
10528@code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
10529
10530Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
10531available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
10532you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
10533
10534Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
10535@itemize @bullet
10536@item
10537to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{ctl-C} on the DOS host---it has
10538no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
10539
10540@item
10541to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
10542normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
10543to detect program completion.
10544@end itemize
10545
10546In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
10547development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
10548
6d2ebf8b 10549@node Hitachi ICE
104c1213
JM
10550@subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
10551
d4f3574e 10552@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi ICE}
104c1213
JM
10553You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
10554Hitachi SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
10555e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
10556
10557@table @code
10558@item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
10559Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
10560@var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
10561@samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
10562(for example, @samp{9600}).
10563
10564@item target e7000 @var{hostname}
10565If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
10566specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
10567@end table
10568
6d2ebf8b 10569@node Hitachi Special
104c1213
JM
10570@subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros
10571
10572Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
10573
10574@table @code
10575
10576@kindex set machine
10577@kindex show machine
10578@item set machine h8300
10579@itemx set machine h8300h
10580Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
10581architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
10582to check which variant is currently in effect.
10583
10584@end table
10585
6d2ebf8b 10586@node H8/500
104c1213
JM
10587@subsection H8/500
10588
10589@table @code
10590
10591@kindex set memory @var{mod}
10592@cindex memory models, H8/500
10593@item set memory @var{mod}
10594@itemx show memory
10595Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
10596@samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
10597memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
10598@code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
10599
10600@end table
10601
6d2ebf8b 10602@node i960
104c1213
JM
10603@subsection Intel i960
10604
10605@table @code
10606
10607@kindex target mon960
10608@item target mon960 @var{dev}
10609MON960 monitor for Intel i960.
10610
f0ca3dce 10611@kindex target nindy
104c1213
JM
10612@item target nindy @var{devicename}
10613An Intel 960 board controlled by a Nindy Monitor. @var{devicename} is
10614the name of the serial device to use for the connection, e.g.
10615@file{/dev/ttya}.
10616
10617@end table
10618
10619@cindex Nindy
10620@cindex i960
10621@dfn{Nindy} is a ROM Monitor program for Intel 960 target systems. When
10622@value{GDBN} is configured to control a remote Intel 960 using Nindy, you can
10623tell @value{GDBN} how to connect to the 960 in several ways:
10624
10625@itemize @bullet
10626@item
10627Through command line options specifying serial port, version of the
10628Nindy protocol, and communications speed;
10629
10630@item
10631By responding to a prompt on startup;
10632
10633@item
10634By using the @code{target} command at any point during your @value{GDBN}
10635session. @xref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}.
10636
104c1213
JM
10637@end itemize
10638
10639@cindex download to Nindy-960
10640With the Nindy interface to an Intel 960 board, @code{load}
10641downloads @var{filename} to the 960 as well as adding its symbols in
10642@value{GDBN}.
10643
10644@menu
10645* Nindy Startup:: Startup with Nindy
10646* Nindy Options:: Options for Nindy
10647* Nindy Reset:: Nindy reset command
10648@end menu
10649
6d2ebf8b 10650@node Nindy Startup
104c1213
JM
10651@subsubsection Startup with Nindy
10652
10653If you simply start @code{@value{GDBP}} without using any command-line
10654options, you are prompted for what serial port to use, @emph{before} you
10655reach the ordinary @value{GDBN} prompt:
10656
10657@example
5d161b24 10658Attach /dev/ttyNN -- specify NN, or "quit" to quit:
104c1213
JM
10659@end example
10660
10661@noindent
10662Respond to the prompt with whatever suffix (after @samp{/dev/tty})
10663identifies the serial port you want to use. You can, if you choose,
10664simply start up with no Nindy connection by responding to the prompt
10665with an empty line. If you do this and later wish to attach to Nindy,
10666use @code{target} (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
10667
6d2ebf8b 10668@node Nindy Options
104c1213
JM
10669@subsubsection Options for Nindy
10670
10671These are the startup options for beginning your @value{GDBN} session with a
10672Nindy-960 board attached:
10673
10674@table @code
10675@item -r @var{port}
10676Specify the serial port name of a serial interface to be used to connect
10677to the target system. This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is
10678configured for the Intel 960 target architecture. You may specify
10679@var{port} as any of: a full pathname (e.g. @samp{-r /dev/ttya}), a
10680device name in @file{/dev} (e.g. @samp{-r ttya}), or simply the unique
10681suffix for a specific @code{tty} (e.g. @samp{-r a}).
10682
10683@item -O
10684(An uppercase letter ``O'', not a zero.) Specify that @value{GDBN} should use
10685the ``old'' Nindy monitor protocol to connect to the target system.
10686This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is configured for the Intel 960
10687target architecture.
10688
10689@quotation
10690@emph{Warning:} if you specify @samp{-O}, but are actually trying to
10691connect to a target system that expects the newer protocol, the connection
10692fails, appearing to be a speed mismatch. @value{GDBN} repeatedly
10693attempts to reconnect at several different line speeds. You can abort
10694this process with an interrupt.
10695@end quotation
10696
10697@item -brk
10698Specify that @value{GDBN} should first send a @code{BREAK} signal to the target
10699system, in an attempt to reset it, before connecting to a Nindy target.
10700
10701@quotation
10702@emph{Warning:} Many target systems do not have the hardware that this
10703requires; it only works with a few boards.
10704@end quotation
10705@end table
10706
10707The standard @samp{-b} option controls the line speed used on the serial
10708port.
10709
10710@c @group
6d2ebf8b 10711@node Nindy Reset
104c1213
JM
10712@subsubsection Nindy reset command
10713
10714@table @code
10715@item reset
10716@kindex reset
10717For a Nindy target, this command sends a ``break'' to the remote target
10718system; this is only useful if the target has been equipped with a
10719circuit to perform a hard reset (or some other interesting action) when
10720a break is detected.
10721@end table
10722@c @end group
10723
6d2ebf8b 10724@node M32R/D
104c1213
JM
10725@subsection Mitsubishi M32R/D
10726
10727@table @code
10728
10729@kindex target m32r
10730@item target m32r @var{dev}
10731Mitsubishi M32R/D ROM monitor.
10732
10733@end table
10734
6d2ebf8b 10735@node M68K
104c1213
JM
10736@subsection M68k
10737
10738The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
10739target command for the following ROM monitors.
10740
10741@table @code
10742
10743@kindex target abug
10744@item target abug @var{dev}
10745ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
10746
10747@kindex target cpu32bug
10748@item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
10749CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
10750
10751@kindex target dbug
10752@item target dbug @var{dev}
10753dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
10754
10755@kindex target est
10756@item target est @var{dev}
10757EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
10758
10759@kindex target rom68k
10760@item target rom68k @var{dev}
10761ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
10762
10763@end table
10764
10765If @value{GDBN} is configured with @code{m68*-ericsson-*}, it will
10766instead have only a single special target command:
10767
10768@table @code
10769
10770@kindex target es1800
10771@item target es1800 @var{dev}
10772ES-1800 emulator for M68K.
10773
10774@end table
10775
10776[context?]
10777
10778@table @code
10779
10780@kindex target rombug
10781@item target rombug @var{dev}
10782ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
10783
10784@end table
10785
6d2ebf8b 10786@node M88K
104c1213
JM
10787@subsection M88K
10788
10789@table @code
10790
10791@kindex target bug
10792@item target bug @var{dev}
10793BUG monitor, running on a MVME187 (m88k) board.
10794
10795@end table
10796
6d2ebf8b 10797@node MIPS Embedded
104c1213
JM
10798@subsection MIPS Embedded
10799
10800@cindex MIPS boards
10801@value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
10802MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
10803you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
10804
10805@need 1000
10806Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
10807
10808@table @code
10809@item target mips @var{port}
10810@kindex target mips @var{port}
10811To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
10812name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
10813command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
10814the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
10815been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
10816download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
10817
10818For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
10819port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
10820debugger:
10821
10822@example
10823host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
2df3850c
JM
10824@value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
10825(@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
10826(@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
10827(@value{GDBP}) run
104c1213
JM
10828@end example
10829
10830@item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
10831On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
10832connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
10833concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
10834@samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
10835
10836@item target pmon @var{port}
10837@kindex target pmon @var{port}
10838PMON ROM monitor.
10839
10840@item target ddb @var{port}
10841@kindex target ddb @var{port}
10842NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
10843
10844@item target lsi @var{port}
10845@kindex target lsi @var{port}
10846LSI variant of PMON.
10847
10848@kindex target r3900
10849@item target r3900 @var{dev}
10850Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
10851
10852@kindex target array
10853@item target array @var{dev}
10854Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
10855
10856@end table
10857
10858
10859@noindent
10860@value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
10861
10862@table @code
10863@item set processor @var{args}
10864@itemx show processor
10865@kindex set processor @var{args}
10866@kindex show processor
10867Use the @code{set processor} command to set the type of MIPS
10868processor when you want to access processor-type-specific registers.
5d161b24 10869For example, @code{set processor @var{r3041}} tells @value{GDBN}
104c1213 10870to use the CPO registers appropriate for the 3041 chip.
5d161b24 10871Use the @code{show processor} command to see what MIPS processor @value{GDBN}
104c1213 10872is using. Use the @code{info reg} command to see what registers
5d161b24 10873@value{GDBN} is using.
104c1213
JM
10874
10875@item set mipsfpu double
10876@itemx set mipsfpu single
10877@itemx set mipsfpu none
10878@itemx show mipsfpu
10879@kindex set mipsfpu
10880@kindex show mipsfpu
10881@cindex MIPS remote floating point
10882@cindex floating point, MIPS remote
10883If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
10884coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
96a2c332 10885need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
104c1213
JM
10886file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
10887functions which return floating point values. It also allows
10888@value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
10889functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
10890with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
10891processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
10892double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
10893@samp{set mipsfpu double}.
10894
10895In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
10896floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
10897and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
10898
10899As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
10900@samp{show mipsfpu}.
10901
10902@item set remotedebug @var{n}
10903@itemx show remotedebug
d4f3574e
SS
10904@kindex set remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
10905@kindex show remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
104c1213
JM
10906@cindex @code{remotedebug}, MIPS protocol
10907@cindex MIPS @code{remotedebug} protocol
10908@c FIXME! For this to be useful, you must know something about the MIPS
10909@c FIXME...protocol. Where is it described?
10910You can see some debugging information about communications with the board
10911by setting the @code{remotedebug} variable. If you set it to @code{1} using
10912@samp{set remotedebug 1}, every packet is displayed. If you set it
10913to @code{2}, every character is displayed. You can check the current value
10914at any time with the command @samp{show remotedebug}.
10915
10916@item set timeout @var{seconds}
10917@itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
10918@itemx show timeout
10919@itemx show retransmit-timeout
10920@cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
10921@cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
10922@kindex set timeout
10923@kindex show timeout
10924@kindex set retransmit-timeout
10925@kindex show retransmit-timeout
10926You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
10927remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
10928default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
10929waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
10930retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
10931You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
10932retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
10933@value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
10934
10935The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
10936is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
10937forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
10938to run before stopping.
10939@end table
10940
6d2ebf8b 10941@node PowerPC
104c1213
JM
10942@subsection PowerPC
10943
10944@table @code
10945
10946@kindex target dink32
10947@item target dink32 @var{dev}
10948DINK32 ROM monitor.
10949
10950@kindex target ppcbug
10951@item target ppcbug @var{dev}
10952@kindex target ppcbug1
10953@item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
10954PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
10955
10956@kindex target sds
10957@item target sds @var{dev}
10958SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
10959
10960@end table
10961
6d2ebf8b 10962@node PA
104c1213
JM
10963@subsection HP PA Embedded
10964
10965@table @code
10966
10967@kindex target op50n
10968@item target op50n @var{dev}
10969OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
10970
10971@kindex target w89k
10972@item target w89k @var{dev}
10973W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
10974
10975@end table
10976
6d2ebf8b 10977@node SH
104c1213
JM
10978@subsection Hitachi SH
10979
10980@table @code
10981
d4f3574e 10982@kindex target hms@r{, with Hitachi SH}
104c1213
JM
10983@item target hms @var{dev}
10984A Hitachi SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
10985commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
10986the communications speed used.
10987
d4f3574e 10988@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi SH}
104c1213
JM
10989@item target e7000 @var{dev}
10990E7000 emulator for Hitachi SH.
10991
d4f3574e
SS
10992@kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
10993@kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
104c1213
JM
10994@item target sh3 @var{dev}
10995@item target sh3e @var{dev}
10996Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
10997
10998@end table
10999
6d2ebf8b 11000@node Sparclet
104c1213
JM
11001@subsection Tsqware Sparclet
11002
11003@cindex Sparclet
11004
5d161b24
DB
11005@value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
11006Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
104c1213
JM
11007@value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
11008both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
5d161b24 11009@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
104c1213
JM
11010
11011@table @code
f0ca3dce 11012@item remotetimeout @var{args}
104c1213 11013@kindex remotetimeout
5d161b24
DB
11014@value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
11015This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
11016seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
104c1213
JM
11017@end table
11018
41afff9a 11019@cindex compiling, on Sparclet
5d161b24 11020When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
d4f3574e 11021information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
5d161b24 11022load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
d4f3574e 11023@samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
104c1213
JM
11024
11025@example
11026sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
11027@end example
11028
d4f3574e 11029You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
104c1213
JM
11030
11031@example
11032sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
11033@end example
11034
41afff9a 11035@cindex running, on Sparclet
104c1213
JM
11036Once you have set
11037your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
5d161b24 11038run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
104c1213
JM
11039(or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
11040
11041@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
11042
11043@example
11044(gdbslet)
11045@end example
11046
11047@menu
11048* Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
11049* Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
11050* Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
5d161b24 11051* Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
104c1213
JM
11052@end menu
11053
6d2ebf8b 11054@node Sparclet File
104c1213
JM
11055@subsubsection Setting file to debug
11056
11057The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
11058
11059@example
11060(gdbslet) file prog
11061@end example
11062
11063@need 1000
11064@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
11065@value{GDBN} locates
11066the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
11067path.
11068If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
11069files will be searched as well.
11070@value{GDBN} locates
11071the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
11072path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
11073If it fails
11074to find a file, it displays a message such as:
11075
11076@example
11077prog: No such file or directory.
11078@end example
11079
11080When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
5d161b24 11081the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
104c1213
JM
11082@code{target} command again.
11083
6d2ebf8b 11084@node Sparclet Connection
104c1213
JM
11085@subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
11086
11087The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
11088To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
11089
11090@example
11091(gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
11092Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
5d161b24 11093main () at ../prog.c:3
104c1213
JM
11094@end example
11095
11096@need 750
11097@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
11098
d4f3574e 11099@example
104c1213 11100Connected to ttya.
d4f3574e 11101@end example
104c1213 11102
6d2ebf8b 11103@node Sparclet Download
104c1213
JM
11104@subsubsection Sparclet download
11105
11106@cindex download to Sparclet
5d161b24 11107Once connected to the Sparclet target,
104c1213
JM
11108you can use the @value{GDBN}
11109@code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
11110The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
11111command.
5d161b24 11112Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
d4f3574e 11113address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
104c1213
JM
11114offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
11115of each of the file's sections.
11116For instance, if the program
11117@file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
11118and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
11119
11120@example
11121(gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
11122Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
11123@end example
11124
5d161b24
DB
11125If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
11126to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
104c1213
JM
11127to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
11128
6d2ebf8b 11129@node Sparclet Execution
104c1213
JM
11130@subsubsection Running and debugging
11131
11132@cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
11133You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
5d161b24 11134commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
104c1213
JM
11135manual for the list of commands.
11136
11137@example
11138(gdbslet) b main
11139Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
5d161b24 11140(gdbslet) run
104c1213
JM
11141Starting program: prog
11142Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
111433 char *symarg = 0;
11144(gdbslet) step
111454 char *execarg = "hello!";
5d161b24 11146(gdbslet)
104c1213
JM
11147@end example
11148
6d2ebf8b 11149@node Sparclite
104c1213
JM
11150@subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
11151
11152@table @code
11153
11154@kindex target sparclite
11155@item target sparclite @var{dev}
5d161b24
DB
11156Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
11157You must use an additional command to debug the program.
11158For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
104c1213
JM
11159remote protocol.
11160
11161@end table
11162
6d2ebf8b 11163@node ST2000
104c1213
JM
11164@subsection Tandem ST2000
11165
2df3850c 11166@value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
104c1213
JM
11167STDBUG protocol.
11168
11169To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
11170manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
11171
11172@example
11173target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
11174@end example
11175
11176@noindent
11177to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
11178the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
11179ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
11180connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
11181concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
11182
11183The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
11184this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
11185would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
11186(such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
11187available on your host computer.
11188@c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
11189@c basically hearsay.
11190
11191@cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
11192These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
11193environment:
11194
11195@table @code
11196@item st2000 @var{command}
11197@kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
11198@cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
11199@cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
11200Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
11201manual for available commands.
11202
11203@item connect
11204@cindex connect (to STDBUG)
11205Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
11206you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
11207sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
11208@kbd{@key{RET}~.} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
11209@kbd{@key{RET}~@key{C-d}} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
11210@end table
11211
6d2ebf8b 11212@node Z8000
104c1213
JM
11213@subsection Zilog Z8000
11214
11215@cindex Z8000
11216@cindex simulator, Z8000
11217@cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
11218
11219When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
11220a Z8000 simulator.
11221
11222For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
11223unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
11224segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
11225appropriate by inspecting the object code.
11226
11227@table @code
11228@item target sim @var{args}
11229@kindex sim
d4f3574e 11230@kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
104c1213
JM
11231Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
11232options, specify them via @var{args}.
11233@end table
11234
11235@noindent
11236After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
11237CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
11238@code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
11239to run your program, and so on.
11240
d4f3574e
SS
11241As well as making available all the usual machine registers
11242(@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
11243additional items of information as specially named registers:
104c1213
JM
11244
11245@table @code
11246
11247@item cycles
11248Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
11249
11250@item insts
11251Counts instructions run in the simulator.
11252
11253@item time
11254Execution time in 60ths of a second.
11255
11256@end table
11257
11258You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
11259conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
11260conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
11261simulated clock ticks.
11262
6d2ebf8b 11263@node Architectures
104c1213
JM
11264@section Architectures
11265
11266This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
2df3850c 11267all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
104c1213
JM
11268
11269@menu
11270* A29K::
11271* Alpha::
11272* MIPS::
11273@end menu
11274
6d2ebf8b 11275@node A29K
104c1213
JM
11276@subsection A29K
11277
11278@table @code
11279
11280@kindex set rstack_high_address
11281@cindex AMD 29K register stack
11282@cindex register stack, AMD29K
11283@item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
11284On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
d4f3574e 11285@dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
104c1213
JM
11286extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
11287stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
11288memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
11289this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
11290the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
11291address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
11292hexadecimal.
11293
11294@kindex show rstack_high_address
11295@item show rstack_high_address
11296Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
11297processors.
11298
11299@end table
11300
6d2ebf8b 11301@node Alpha
104c1213
JM
11302@subsection Alpha
11303
11304See the following section.
11305
6d2ebf8b 11306@node MIPS
104c1213
JM
11307@subsection MIPS
11308
11309@cindex stack on Alpha
11310@cindex stack on MIPS
11311@cindex Alpha stack
11312@cindex MIPS stack
11313Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
11314sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
11315find the beginning of a function.
11316
11317@cindex response time, MIPS debugging
11318To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
11319@value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
11320you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
11321commands:
11322
11323@table @code
00e4a2e4 11324@cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
104c1213
JM
11325@item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
11326Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
11327search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
11328default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
11329larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
11330and therefore the longer it takes to run.
11331
11332@item show heuristic-fence-post
11333Display the current limit.
11334@end table
11335
11336@noindent
11337These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
11338for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
11339
11340
6d2ebf8b 11341@node Controlling GDB
c906108c
SS
11342@chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
11343
53a5351d
JM
11344You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
11345@code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
d4f3574e 11346data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
53a5351d 11347described here.
c906108c
SS
11348
11349@menu
11350* Prompt:: Prompt
11351* Editing:: Command editing
11352* History:: Command history
11353* Screen Size:: Screen size
11354* Numbers:: Numbers
11355* Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
5d161b24 11356* Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
c906108c
SS
11357@end menu
11358
6d2ebf8b 11359@node Prompt
c906108c
SS
11360@section Prompt
11361
11362@cindex prompt
11363
11364@value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
11365called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
11366can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
11367instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
5d161b24 11368the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
c906108c
SS
11369which one you are talking to.
11370
d4f3574e 11371@emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
c906108c
SS
11372prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
11373or a prompt that does not.
11374
11375@table @code
11376@kindex set prompt
11377@item set prompt @var{newprompt}
11378Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
11379
11380@kindex show prompt
11381@item show prompt
11382Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
11383@end table
11384
6d2ebf8b 11385@node Editing
c906108c
SS
11386@section Command editing
11387@cindex readline
11388@cindex command line editing
11389
11390@value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{readline} interface. This
11391@sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
11392command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
11393or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
11394substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
11395debugging sessions.
11396
11397You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
11398command @code{set}.
11399
11400@table @code
11401@kindex set editing
11402@cindex editing
11403@item set editing
11404@itemx set editing on
11405Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
11406
11407@item set editing off
11408Disable command line editing.
11409
11410@kindex show editing
11411@item show editing
11412Show whether command line editing is enabled.
11413@end table
11414
6d2ebf8b 11415@node History
c906108c
SS
11416@section Command history
11417
11418@value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
11419debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
11420happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
11421history facility.
11422
11423@table @code
11424@cindex history substitution
11425@cindex history file
11426@kindex set history filename
11427@kindex GDBHISTFILE
11428@item set history filename @var{fname}
11429Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
11430This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
11431list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
11432exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
11433the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
11434to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
d4f3574e
SS
11435@file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
11436is not set.
c906108c
SS
11437
11438@cindex history save
11439@kindex set history save
11440@item set history save
11441@itemx set history save on
11442Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
11443@code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
11444
11445@item set history save off
11446Stop recording command history in a file.
11447
11448@cindex history size
11449@kindex set history size
11450@item set history size @var{size}
11451Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
11452This defaults to the value of the environment variable
11453@code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
11454@end table
11455
11456@cindex history expansion
11457History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
11458@ifset have-readline-appendices
11459@xref{Event Designators}.
11460@end ifset
11461
11462Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
11463is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
11464@code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
11465follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
11466a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
11467history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
11468@kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
11469
11470The commands to control history expansion are:
11471
11472@table @code
11473@kindex set history expansion
11474@item set history expansion on
11475@itemx set history expansion
11476Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
11477
11478@item set history expansion off
11479Disable history expansion.
11480
11481The readline code comes with more complete documentation of
11482editing and history expansion features. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs
11483or @code{vi} may wish to read it.
11484@ifset have-readline-appendices
11485@xref{Command Line Editing}.
11486@end ifset
11487
11488@c @group
11489@kindex show history
11490@item show history
11491@itemx show history filename
11492@itemx show history save
11493@itemx show history size
11494@itemx show history expansion
11495These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
11496@code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
11497@c @end group
11498@end table
11499
11500@table @code
41afff9a 11501@kindex shows
c906108c
SS
11502@item show commands
11503Display the last ten commands in the command history.
11504
11505@item show commands @var{n}
11506Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
11507
11508@item show commands +
11509Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
11510@end table
11511
6d2ebf8b 11512@node Screen Size
c906108c
SS
11513@section Screen size
11514@cindex size of screen
11515@cindex pauses in output
11516
11517Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
11518information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
11519@value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
11520output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
11521to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
11522determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
11523printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
11524rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
11525
d4f3574e
SS
11526Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
11527driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
c906108c 11528together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
d4f3574e 11529@code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
c906108c
SS
11530you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
11531width} commands:
11532
11533@table @code
11534@kindex set height
11535@kindex set width
11536@kindex show width
11537@kindex show height
11538@item set height @var{lpp}
11539@itemx show height
11540@itemx set width @var{cpl}
11541@itemx show width
11542These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
11543a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
11544commands display the current settings.
11545
5d161b24
DB
11546If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
11547output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
c906108c
SS
11548file or to an editor buffer.
11549
11550Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
11551from wrapping its output.
11552@end table
11553
6d2ebf8b 11554@node Numbers
c906108c
SS
11555@section Numbers
11556@cindex number representation
11557@cindex entering numbers
11558
2df3850c
JM
11559You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
11560@value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
11561@samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
11562begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that begin with none of these are, by
11563default, entered in base 10; likewise, the default display for
11564numbers---when no particular format is specified---is base 10. You can
11565change the default base for both input and output with the @code{set
11566radix} command.
c906108c
SS
11567
11568@table @code
11569@kindex set input-radix
11570@item set input-radix @var{base}
11571Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
11572for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
11573specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix; for
11574example, any of
11575
11576@smallexample
11577set radix 012
11578set radix 10.
11579set radix 0xa
11580@end smallexample
11581
11582@noindent
11583sets the base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set radix 10}
11584leaves the radix unchanged no matter what it was.
11585
11586@kindex set output-radix
11587@item set output-radix @var{base}
11588Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
11589for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
11590specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix.
11591
11592@kindex show input-radix
11593@item show input-radix
11594Display the current default base for numeric input.
11595
11596@kindex show output-radix
11597@item show output-radix
11598Display the current default base for numeric display.
11599@end table
11600
6d2ebf8b 11601@node Messages/Warnings
c906108c
SS
11602@section Optional warnings and messages
11603
2df3850c
JM
11604By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
11605running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
11606command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
11607internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
c906108c
SS
11608
11609Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
11610which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
11611see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
11612
11613@table @code
11614@kindex set verbose
11615@item set verbose on
11616Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
11617
11618@item set verbose off
11619Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
11620
11621@kindex show verbose
11622@item show verbose
11623Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
11624@end table
11625
2df3850c
JM
11626By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
11627object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
11628find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
11629symbol files}).
c906108c
SS
11630
11631@table @code
2df3850c 11632
c906108c
SS
11633@kindex set complaints
11634@item set complaints @var{limit}
2df3850c
JM
11635Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
11636unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
11637@var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
11638to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
c906108c
SS
11639
11640@kindex show complaints
11641@item show complaints
11642Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
2df3850c 11643
c906108c
SS
11644@end table
11645
11646By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
11647lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
11648you try to run a program which is already running:
11649
11650@example
11651(@value{GDBP}) run
11652The program being debugged has been started already.
11653Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
11654@end example
11655
11656If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
11657commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
11658
11659@table @code
2df3850c 11660
c906108c
SS
11661@kindex set confirm
11662@cindex flinching
11663@cindex confirmation
11664@cindex stupid questions
11665@item set confirm off
11666Disables confirmation requests.
11667
11668@item set confirm on
11669Enables confirmation requests (the default).
11670
11671@kindex show confirm
11672@item show confirm
11673Displays state of confirmation requests.
2df3850c 11674
c906108c
SS
11675@end table
11676
6d2ebf8b 11677@node Debugging Output
5d161b24
DB
11678@section Optional messages about internal happenings
11679@table @code
11680@kindex set debug arch
11681@item set debug arch
11682Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
11683@kindex show debug arch
11684@item show debug arch
11685Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
11686@kindex set debug event
11687@item set debug event
11688Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
11689default is off.
11690@kindex show debug event
11691@item show debug event
11692Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
11693info.
11694@kindex set debug expression
11695@item set debug expression
11696Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} expression debugging info. The
11697default is off.
11698@kindex show debug expression
11699@item show debug expression
11700Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} expression
11701debugging info.
11702@kindex set debug overload
11703@item set debug overload
11704Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C++ overload debugging
11705info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
11706is off.
11707@kindex show debug overload
11708@item show debug overload
11709Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C++ overload
11710debugging info.
11711@kindex set debug remote
11712@cindex packets, reporting on stdout
11713@cindex serial connections, debugging
11714@item set debug remote
11715Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
11716the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
11717@value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
11718@kindex show debug remote
11719@item show debug remote
11720Displays the state of display of remote packets.
11721@kindex set debug serial
11722@item set debug serial
11723Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
11724default is off.
11725@kindex show debug serial
11726@item show debug serial
11727Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
11728info.
11729@kindex set debug target
11730@item set debug target
11731Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
11732includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
11733default is off.
11734@kindex show debug target
11735@item show debug target
11736Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
11737info.
11738@kindex set debug varobj
11739@item set debug varobj
11740Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
11741info. The default is off.
11742@kindex show debug varobj
11743@item show debug varobj
11744Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
11745debugging info.
11746@end table
11747
6d2ebf8b 11748@node Sequences
c906108c
SS
11749@chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
11750
11751Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
2df3850c
JM
11752command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
11753commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
11754files.
c906108c
SS
11755
11756@menu
11757* Define:: User-defined commands
11758* Hooks:: User-defined command hooks
11759* Command Files:: Command files
11760* Output:: Commands for controlled output
11761@end menu
11762
6d2ebf8b 11763@node Define
c906108c
SS
11764@section User-defined commands
11765
11766@cindex user-defined command
2df3850c
JM
11767A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
11768which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
11769@code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
11770separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
11771via @var{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
c906108c
SS
11772
11773@smallexample
11774define adder
11775 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
11776@end smallexample
11777
d4f3574e
SS
11778@noindent
11779To execute the command use:
c906108c
SS
11780
11781@smallexample
11782adder 1 2 3
11783@end smallexample
11784
d4f3574e
SS
11785@noindent
11786This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
5d161b24 11787its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
c906108c
SS
11788reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
11789functions calls.
11790
11791@table @code
2df3850c 11792
c906108c
SS
11793@kindex define
11794@item define @var{commandname}
11795Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
11796by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
11797
11798The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
11799which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
11800commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
11801
11802@kindex if
11803@kindex else
11804@item if
11805Takes a single argument, which is an expression to evaluate.
11806It is followed by a series of commands that are executed
11807only if the expression is true (nonzero).
11808There can then optionally be a line @code{else}, followed
11809by a series of commands that are only executed if the expression
11810was false. The end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
11811
11812@kindex while
11813@item while
11814The syntax is similar to @code{if}: the command takes a single argument,
11815which is an expression to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to
11816execute, one per line, terminated by an @code{end}.
11817The commands are executed repeatedly as long as the expression
11818evaluates to true.
11819
11820@kindex document
11821@item document @var{commandname}
11822Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
5d161b24
DB
11823accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
11824defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
11825reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
11826After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
c906108c
SS
11827@var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
11828
11829You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
11830documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
11831does not change the documentation.
11832
11833@kindex help user-defined
11834@item help user-defined
11835List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
11836(if any) for each.
11837
11838@kindex show user
11839@item show user
11840@itemx show user @var{commandname}
2df3850c
JM
11841Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
11842not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
c906108c 11843definitions for all user-defined commands.
2df3850c 11844
c906108c
SS
11845@end table
11846
11847When user-defined commands are executed, the
11848commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
11849stops execution of the user-defined command.
11850
11851If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
5d161b24
DB
11852without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
11853commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
c906108c
SS
11854messages when used in a user-defined command.
11855
6d2ebf8b 11856@node Hooks
c906108c 11857@section User-defined command hooks
d4f3574e
SS
11858@cindex command hooks
11859@cindex hooks, for commands
c906108c
SS
11860
11861You may define @emph{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
11862command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
11863command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
11864before that command.
11865
d4f3574e 11866@kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
c906108c
SS
11867In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
11868(@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
11869execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
11870displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
11871
c906108c
SS
11872For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
11873single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
11874you could define:
11875
11876@example
11877define hook-stop
11878handle SIGALRM nopass
11879end
11880
11881define hook-run
11882handle SIGALRM pass
11883end
11884
11885define hook-continue
11886handle SIGLARM pass
11887end
11888@end example
c906108c
SS
11889
11890You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
11891not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
11892name, e.g. @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
11893@c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
11894@c or not?
11895If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
11896@value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
11897(before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
11898
11899If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
11900get a warning from the @code{define} command.
11901
6d2ebf8b 11902@node Command Files
c906108c
SS
11903@section Command files
11904
11905@cindex command files
5d161b24
DB
11906A command file for @value{GDBN} is a file of lines that are @value{GDBN}
11907commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may also be included.
11908An empty line in a command file does nothing; it does not mean to repeat
c906108c
SS
11909the last command, as it would from the terminal.
11910
11911@cindex init file
11912@cindex @file{.gdbinit}
d4f3574e 11913@cindex @file{gdb.ini}
c906108c 11914When you start @value{GDBN}, it automatically executes commands from its
bf0184be
ND
11915@dfn{init files}. These are files named @file{.gdbinit} on Unix and
11916@file{gdb.ini} on DOS/Windows. During startup, @value{GDBN} does the
11917following:
11918
11919@enumerate
11920@item
11921Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
11922DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
11923@code{HOME} environment variable.}.
11924
11925@item
11926Processes command line options and operands.
11927
11928@item
11929Reads the init file (if any) in the current working directory.
11930
11931@item
11932Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option.
11933@end enumerate
11934
11935The init file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
11936complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
11937and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
11938option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}).
c906108c 11939
c906108c
SS
11940@cindex init file name
11941On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
11942different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
11943form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
11944different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
11945environments with special init file names:
11946
00e4a2e4 11947@cindex @file{.vxgdbinit}
c906108c
SS
11948@itemize @bullet
11949@item
00e4a2e4 11950VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @file{.vxgdbinit}
c906108c 11951
00e4a2e4 11952@cindex @file{.os68gdbinit}
c906108c 11953@item
00e4a2e4 11954OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @file{.os68gdbinit}
c906108c 11955
00e4a2e4 11956@cindex @file{.esgdbinit}
c906108c 11957@item
00e4a2e4 11958ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @file{.esgdbinit}
c906108c 11959@end itemize
c906108c
SS
11960
11961You can also request the execution of a command file with the
11962@code{source} command:
11963
11964@table @code
11965@kindex source
11966@item source @var{filename}
11967Execute the command file @var{filename}.
11968@end table
11969
11970The lines in a command file are executed sequentially. They are not
11971printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates execution
11972of the command file.
11973
11974Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
11975without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
11976normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
11977when called from command files.
11978
6d2ebf8b 11979@node Output
c906108c
SS
11980@section Commands for controlled output
11981
11982During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
11983@value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
11984explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
11985describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
11986want.
11987
11988@table @code
11989@kindex echo
11990@item echo @var{text}
11991@c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
11992@c because it is not in ANSI.
11993Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
11994@var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
11995newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
11996In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
11997by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
11998string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
5d161b24 11999trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
c906108c
SS
12000To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
12001@samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
12002
12003A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
12004the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
12005
12006@example
12007echo This is some text\n\
12008which is continued\n\
12009onto several lines.\n
12010@end example
12011
12012produces the same output as
12013
12014@example
12015echo This is some text\n
12016echo which is continued\n
12017echo onto several lines.\n
12018@end example
12019
12020@kindex output
12021@item output @var{expression}
12022Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
12023newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
5d161b24 12024value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
c906108c
SS
12025on expressions.
12026
12027@item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
12028Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
12029the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
12030formats}, for more information.
12031
12032@kindex printf
12033@item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
12034Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
12035@var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
12036either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
12037@var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
12038subroutine
d4f3574e
SS
12039@c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
12040@c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
12041@c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
12042@c supported.
c906108c
SS
12043
12044@example
12045printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
12046@end example
12047
12048For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
12049
12050@smallexample
12051printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
12052@end smallexample
12053
12054The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
12055string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
12056letter.
12057@end table
12058
6d2ebf8b 12059@node Emacs
c906108c
SS
12060@chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
12061
12062@cindex Emacs
12063@cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
12064A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
12065edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
12066@value{GDBN}.
12067
12068To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
12069executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
12070@value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
12071created Emacs buffer.
53a5351d 12072@c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
c906108c
SS
12073
12074Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
12075things:
12076
12077@itemize @bullet
12078@item
12079All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
12080@end itemize
12081
12082This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
12083and output done by the program you are debugging.
12084
12085This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
12086commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
12087in this way.
12088
12089All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
12090with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
12091way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
12092stop.
12093
12094@itemize @bullet
12095@item
12096@value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
12097@end itemize
12098
12099Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
12100source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
12101left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
12102source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
12103and the source.
12104
12105Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
12106usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
12107
12108@quotation
12109@emph{Warning:} If the directory where your program resides is not your
12110current directory, it can be easy to confuse Emacs about the location of
12111the source files, in which case the auxiliary display buffer does not
12112appear to show your source. @value{GDBN} can find programs by searching your
12113environment's @code{PATH} variable, so the @value{GDBN} input and output
12114session proceeds normally; but Emacs does not get enough information
12115back from @value{GDBN} to locate the source files in this situation. To
12116avoid this problem, either start @value{GDBN} mode from the directory where
12117your program resides, or specify an absolute file name when prompted for the
12118@kbd{M-x gdb} argument.
12119
12120A similar confusion can result if you use the @value{GDBN} @code{file} command to
12121switch to debugging a program in some other location, from an existing
12122@value{GDBN} buffer in Emacs.
12123@end quotation
12124
12125By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If
12126you need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you keep
12127several configurations around, with different names) you can set the
12128Emacs variable @code{gdb-command-name}; for example,
12129
12130@example
12131(setq gdb-command-name "mygdb")
12132@end example
12133
12134@noindent
d4f3574e 12135(preceded by @kbd{M-:} or @kbd{ESC :}, or typed in the @code{*scratch*} buffer, or
c906108c
SS
12136in your @file{.emacs} file) makes Emacs call the program named
12137``@code{mygdb}'' instead.
12138
12139In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
12140addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
12141
12142@table @kbd
12143@item C-h m
12144Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
12145
12146@item M-s
12147Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
12148update the display window to show the current file and location.
12149
12150@item M-n
12151Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
12152calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
12153to show the current file and location.
12154
12155@item M-i
12156Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
12157display window accordingly.
12158
12159@item M-x gdb-nexti
12160Execute to next instruction, using the @value{GDBN} @code{nexti} command; update
12161display window accordingly.
12162
12163@item C-c C-f
12164Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
12165@code{finish} command.
12166
12167@item M-c
12168Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
12169command.
12170
12171@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-p}.
12172
12173@item M-u
12174Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
12175(@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
12176like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
12177
12178@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-u}.
12179
12180@item M-d
12181Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
12182@value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
12183
12184@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-d}.
12185
12186@item C-x &
12187Read the number where the cursor is positioned, and insert it at the end
12188of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer. For example, if you wish to disassemble code
12189around an address that was displayed earlier, type @kbd{disassemble};
12190then move the cursor to the address display, and pick up the
12191argument for @code{disassemble} by typing @kbd{C-x &}.
12192
12193You can customize this further by defining elements of the list
12194@code{gdb-print-command}; once it is defined, you can format or
12195otherwise process numbers picked up by @kbd{C-x &} before they are
12196inserted. A numeric argument to @kbd{C-x &} indicates that you
12197wish special formatting, and also acts as an index to pick an element of the
12198list. If the list element is a string, the number to be inserted is
12199formatted using the Emacs function @code{format}; otherwise the number
12200is passed as an argument to the corresponding list element.
12201@end table
12202
12203In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x SPC} (@code{gdb-break})
12204tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
12205
12206If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
12207it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
12208request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
12209the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
12210frame.
12211
12212The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
12213which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
12214the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
12215communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
12216delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
12217to correspond properly with the code.
12218
12219@c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
12220@c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
12221@ignore
12222@kindex Emacs Epoch environment
12223@kindex Epoch
12224@kindex inspect
12225
5d161b24 12226Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
c906108c
SS
12227called the @code{epoch}
12228environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
12229@code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
12230each value is printed in its own window.
12231@end ignore
c906108c 12232
d700128c 12233@include annotate.texi
7162c0ca 12234@include gdbmi.texinfo
d700128c 12235
6d2ebf8b 12236@node GDB Bugs
c906108c
SS
12237@chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
12238@cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
12239@cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
12240
12241Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
12242
12243Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
12244may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
12245the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
12246reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
12247
12248In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
12249information that enables us to fix the bug.
12250
12251@menu
12252* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
12253* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
12254@end menu
12255
6d2ebf8b 12256@node Bug Criteria
c906108c
SS
12257@section Have you found a bug?
12258@cindex bug criteria
12259
12260If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
12261
12262@itemize @bullet
12263@cindex fatal signal
12264@cindex debugger crash
12265@cindex crash of debugger
12266@item
12267If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
12268@value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
12269
12270@cindex error on valid input
12271@item
12272If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
12273bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
12274somewhere in the connection to the target.)
12275
12276@cindex invalid input
12277@item
12278If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
12279that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
12280``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
12281for traditional practice''.
12282
12283@item
12284If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
12285for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
12286@end itemize
12287
6d2ebf8b 12288@node Bug Reporting
c906108c
SS
12289@section How to report bugs
12290@cindex bug reports
12291@cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
12292
c906108c
SS
12293A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
12294If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
12295contact that organization first.
12296
12297You can find contact information for many support companies and
12298individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
12299distribution.
12300@c should add a web page ref...
12301
12302In any event, we also recommend that you send bug reports for
12303@value{GDBN} to this addresses:
12304
12305@example
d4f3574e 12306bug-gdb@@gnu.org
c906108c
SS
12307@end example
12308
12309@strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
d4f3574e 12310@samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
c906108c
SS
12311not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
12312@samp{bug-gdb}.
12313
12314The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
12315serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
12316the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
12317newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
12318problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
12319path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
12320we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
12321bug reports to the mailing list.
12322
12323As a last resort, send bug reports on paper to:
12324
12325@example
12326@sc{gnu} Debugger Bugs
12327Free Software Foundation Inc.
1232859 Temple Place - Suite 330
12329Boston, MA 02111-1307
12330USA
12331@end example
c906108c
SS
12332
12333The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
12334@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
12335fact or leave it out, state it!
12336
12337Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
12338problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
12339assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
12340Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
12341stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
12342name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
12343of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
12344the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
12345easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
12346
12347Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
12348bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
12349you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
12350self-contained.
12351
12352Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
12353bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
12354@emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
12355bugs properly.
12356
12357To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
12358
12359@itemize @bullet
12360@item
12361The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
12362with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
12363version}.
12364
12365Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
12366the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
12367
12368@item
12369The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
12370version number.
12371
c906108c
SS
12372@item
12373What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.
12374``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
c906108c
SS
12375
12376@item
12377What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
12378debugging---e.g. ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
12379C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
12380information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
12381compilers.
12382
12383@item
12384The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
12385observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
12386you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
12387Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
12388
12389If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
12390and then we might not encounter the bug.
12391
12392@item
12393A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
12394reproduce the bug.
12395
12396@item
12397A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
12398incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
12399
12400Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
12401will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
12402not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
12403a chance to make a mistake.
12404
12405Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
12406say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
12407copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
12408the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
12409crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
12410ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
12411us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
12412to draw any conclusion from our observations.
12413
c906108c
SS
12414@item
12415If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
12416diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
12417it by context, not by line number.
12418
12419The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
12420sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
53a5351d 12421
c906108c
SS
12422@end itemize
12423
12424Here are some things that are not necessary:
12425
12426@itemize @bullet
12427@item
12428A description of the envelope of the bug.
12429
12430Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
12431which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
12432changes will not affect it.
12433
12434This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
12435will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
12436with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
12437We recommend that you save your time for something else.
12438
12439Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
12440of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
12441output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
12442less time, and so on.
12443
12444However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
12445report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
12446
12447@item
12448A patch for the bug.
12449
12450A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
12451the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
12452a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
12453to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
12454
12455Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
12456construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
12457through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
12458to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
12459
12460And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
12461patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
12462help us to understand.
12463
12464@item
12465A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
12466
12467Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
12468things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
12469@end itemize
12470
5d161b24 12471@c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
c906108c
SS
12472@c and consists of the two following files:
12473@c rluser.texinfo
7be570e7 12474@c inc-hist.texinfo
c906108c
SS
12475@c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
12476@c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
12477@include rluser.texinfo
7be570e7 12478@include inc-hist.texinfo
c906108c
SS
12479
12480
6d2ebf8b 12481@node Formatting Documentation
c906108c
SS
12482@appendix Formatting Documentation
12483
12484@cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
12485@cindex reference card
12486The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
12487for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
12488subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
12489@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
12490release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
12491you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
12492
12493The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
12494can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
12495
12496@example
12497make refcard.dvi
12498@end example
12499
5d161b24
DB
12500The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
12501mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
c906108c
SS
12502that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
12503high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
12504your @sc{dvi} output program.
12505
12506@cindex documentation
12507
12508All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
12509distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
12510a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
12511on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
12512formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
12513and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
12514
12515@value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
12516version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
12517file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
12518subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
12519necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
12520but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
12521Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
12522@sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
12523
12524If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
12525Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
12526@code{makeinfo}.
12527
12528If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
12529@value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
12530version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
12531
12532@example
12533cd gdb
12534make gdb.info
12535@end example
12536
12537If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
12538a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
12539Texinfo definitions file.
12540
12541@TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
12542produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
12543document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
12544has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
12545command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
12546(for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
12547require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
12548
12549@TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
12550@file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
12551written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
12552typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
12553and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
12554directory.
12555
12556If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
12557typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
12558subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
12559@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
12560
12561@example
12562make gdb.dvi
12563@end example
12564
12565Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
c906108c 12566
6d2ebf8b 12567@node Installing GDB
c906108c
SS
12568@appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
12569@cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
12570@cindex installation
12571
c906108c
SS
12572@value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
12573of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
12574build the @code{gdb} program.
12575@iftex
12576@c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
12577@footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
12578look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
12579installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
12580@end iftex
12581
5d161b24
DB
12582The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
12583@value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
c906108c
SS
12584appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
12585
12586For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
12587@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
12588
12589@table @code
12590@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
12591script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
12592
12593@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
12594the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
12595
12596@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
12597source for the Binary File Descriptor library
12598
12599@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
12600@sc{gnu} include files
12601
12602@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
12603source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
12604
12605@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
12606source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
12607
12608@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
12609source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
12610
12611@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
12612source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
12613
12614@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
12615source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
12616@end table
12617
12618The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
12619from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
12620this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
12621
12622First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
12623if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
12624identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
12625argument.
12626
12627For example:
12628
12629@example
12630cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
12631./configure @var{host}
12632make
12633@end example
12634
12635@noindent
12636where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
12637@samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
12638(You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
12639correct value by examining your system.)
12640
12641Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
12642@file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
12643libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
12644binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
12645
12646@need 750
12647@code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
12648system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
12649shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
12650
12651@example
12652sh configure @var{host}
12653@end example
12654
12655If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
12656directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
12657@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
12658creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
12659you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
12660
12661You can run the @code{configure} script from any of the
12662subordinate directories in the @value{GDBN} distribution if you only want to
12663configure that subdirectory, but be sure to specify a path to it.
12664
12665For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, type the following to configure only
12666the @code{bfd} subdirectory:
12667
12668@example
12669@group
12670cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
12671../configure @var{host}
12672@end group
12673@end example
12674
12675You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
12676However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
12677the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
12678that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
12679let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
12680
12681@menu
12682* Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
12683* Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
12684* Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
12685@end menu
12686
6d2ebf8b 12687@node Separate Objdir
c906108c
SS
12688@section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
12689
12690If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
12691you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
12692host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
12693allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
12694rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
12695handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
12696@code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
12697program specified there.
12698
12699To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
12700with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
12701(You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
12702itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
12703would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
12704the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
12705
5d161b24 12706For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
c906108c
SS
12707separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
12708
12709@example
12710@group
12711cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
12712mkdir ../gdb-sun4
12713cd ../gdb-sun4
12714../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
12715make
12716@end group
12717@end example
12718
12719When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
12720directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
12721(and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
12722the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
12723directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
12724@file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
12725
12726One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
5d161b24
DB
12727directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
12728@value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
12729programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
c906108c
SS
12730You specify a cross-debugging target by
12731giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
12732
12733When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
12734it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
12735called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
12736
12737The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
12738directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
12739directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
12740directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
12741will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
12742
12743When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
12744directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
12745if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
12746with each other.
12747
6d2ebf8b 12748@node Config Names
c906108c
SS
12749@section Specifying names for hosts and targets
12750
12751The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
12752script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
12753aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
12754of information in the following pattern:
12755
12756@example
12757@var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
12758@end example
12759
12760For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
12761or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
12762option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
12763
12764The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
12765any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
12766aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
12767@code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
12768script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
12769abbreviations---for example:
12770
12771@smallexample
12772% sh config.sub i386-linux
12773i386-pc-linux-gnu
12774% sh config.sub alpha-linux
12775alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
12776% sh config.sub hp9k700
12777hppa1.1-hp-hpux
12778% sh config.sub sun4
12779sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
12780% sh config.sub sun3
12781m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
12782% sh config.sub i986v
12783Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
12784@end smallexample
12785
12786@noindent
12787@code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
12788directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
12789
6d2ebf8b 12790@node Configure Options
c906108c
SS
12791@section @code{configure} options
12792
12793Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
12794are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
12795several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
12796Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
12797
12798@example
12799configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
12800 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
12801 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
12802 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
12803 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
12804 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
12805 @var{host}
12806@end example
12807
12808@noindent
12809You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
12810@samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
12811@samp{--}.
12812
12813@table @code
12814@item --help
12815Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
12816
12817@item --prefix=@var{dir}
12818Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
12819@file{@var{dir}}.
12820
12821@item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
12822Configure the source to install programs under directory
12823@file{@var{dir}}.
12824
12825@c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
12826@need 2000
12827@item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
12828@strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
12829@code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
12830Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
12831@value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
12832build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
12833directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
12834the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
12835directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
12836the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
12837@var{dirname}.
12838
12839@item --norecursion
12840Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
12841propagate configuration to subdirectories.
12842
12843@item --target=@var{target}
12844Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
12845@var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
12846programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
12847
12848There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
12849
12850@item @var{host} @dots{}
12851Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
12852
12853There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
12854@end table
12855
12856There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
12857needed for special purposes only.
5d161b24 12858
6d2ebf8b 12859@node Index
c906108c
SS
12860@unnumbered Index
12861
12862@printindex cp
12863
12864@tex
12865% I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
12866% meantime:
12867\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
12868\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
12869\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
12870\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
12871\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
12872\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
12873\centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
12874\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
12875\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
12876\page\colophon
12877% Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
12878@end tex
12879
12880@contents
12881@bye